1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 //  This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
15 #include "TreeTransform.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
40 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
41 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
42 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
43 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h"
44 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
45 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h"
46 using namespace clang;
47 using namespace sema;
48 
49 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without
50 /// emitting diagnostics.
51 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D) {
52   // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
53   if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D))
54     return false;
55 
56   // See if this is a deleted function.
57   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
58     if (FD->isDeleted())
59       return false;
60 
61     // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
62     // then we can't use it either.
63     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
64         DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false))
65       return false;
66   }
67 
68   // See if this function is unavailable.
69   if (D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable &&
70       cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
71     return false;
72 
73   return true;
74 }
75 
76 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
77   // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
78   if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
79     const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext());
80     if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
81       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
82   }
83 }
84 
85 static bool HasRedeclarationWithoutAvailabilityInCategory(const Decl *D) {
86   const auto *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
87   if (!OMD)
88     return false;
89   const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OID = OMD->getClassInterface();
90   if (!OID)
91     return false;
92 
93   for (const ObjCCategoryDecl *Cat : OID->visible_categories())
94     if (ObjCMethodDecl *CatMeth =
95             Cat->getMethod(OMD->getSelector(), OMD->isInstanceMethod()))
96       if (!CatMeth->hasAttr<AvailabilityAttr>())
97         return true;
98   return false;
99 }
100 
101 static AvailabilityResult
102 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
103                            const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
104                            bool ObjCPropertyAccess) {
105   // See if this declaration is unavailable or deprecated.
106   std::string Message;
107 
108   // Forward class declarations get their attributes from their definition.
109   if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
110     if (IDecl->getDefinition())
111       D = IDecl->getDefinition();
112   }
113   AvailabilityResult Result = D->getAvailability(&Message);
114   if (const EnumConstantDecl *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D))
115     if (Result == AR_Available) {
116       const DeclContext *DC = ECD->getDeclContext();
117       if (const EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(DC))
118         Result = TheEnumDecl->getAvailability(&Message);
119     }
120 
121   const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = nullptr;
122   if (Result == AR_Deprecated || Result == AR_Unavailable ||
123       AR_NotYetIntroduced) {
124     if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
125       if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = MD->findPropertyDecl()) {
126         AvailabilityResult PDeclResult = PD->getAvailability(nullptr);
127         if (PDeclResult == Result)
128           ObjCPDecl = PD;
129       }
130     }
131   }
132 
133   switch (Result) {
134     case AR_Available:
135       break;
136 
137     case AR_Deprecated:
138       if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Deprecated)
139         S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Deprecation,
140                                   D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
141                                   ObjCPropertyAccess);
142       break;
143 
144     case AR_NotYetIntroduced: {
145       // Don't do this for enums, they can't be redeclared.
146       if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<EnumDecl>(D))
147         break;
148 
149       bool Warn = !D->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()->isInherited();
150       // Objective-C method declarations in categories are not modelled as
151       // redeclarations, so manually look for a redeclaration in a category
152       // if necessary.
153       if (Warn && HasRedeclarationWithoutAvailabilityInCategory(D))
154         Warn = false;
155       // In general, D will point to the most recent redeclaration. However,
156       // for `@class A;` decls, this isn't true -- manually go through the
157       // redecl chain in that case.
158       if (Warn && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D))
159         for (Decl *Redecl = D->getMostRecentDecl(); Redecl && Warn;
160              Redecl = Redecl->getPreviousDecl())
161           if (!Redecl->hasAttr<AvailabilityAttr>() ||
162               Redecl->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()->isInherited())
163             Warn = false;
164 
165       if (Warn)
166         S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Partial, D, Message, Loc,
167                                   UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
168                                   ObjCPropertyAccess);
169       break;
170     }
171 
172     case AR_Unavailable:
173       if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
174         S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Unavailable,
175                                   D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
176                                   ObjCPropertyAccess);
177       break;
178 
179     }
180     return Result;
181 }
182 
183 /// \brief Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted.
184 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) {
185   assert(Decl->isDeleted());
186 
187   CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl);
188 
189   if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) {
190     // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration.
191     if (!Method->isImplicit())
192       Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted);
193 
194     // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly
195     // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies.
196     CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method);
197     if (CSM != CXXInvalid)
198       ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, /*Diagnose=*/true);
199 
200     return;
201   }
202 
203   if (CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl)) {
204     if (CXXConstructorDecl *BaseCD =
205             const_cast<CXXConstructorDecl*>(CD->getInheritedConstructor())) {
206       Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_inherited_deleted_here);
207       if (BaseCD->isDeleted()) {
208         NoteDeletedFunction(BaseCD);
209       } else {
210         // FIXME: An explanation of why exactly it can't be inherited
211         // would be nice.
212         Diag(BaseCD->getLocation(), diag::note_cannot_inherit);
213       }
214       return;
215     }
216   }
217 
218   Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here)
219     << Decl << true;
220 }
221 
222 /// \brief Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an
223 /// explicit storage class.
224 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) {
225   for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
226     if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None)
227       return true;
228   }
229   return false;
230 }
231 
232 /// \brief Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a
233 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3).
234 ///
235 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but
236 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode
237 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6)
238 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't
239 /// prove that there are errors.
240 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S,
241                                                       const NamedDecl *D,
242                                                       SourceLocation Loc) {
243   // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in
244   // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically
245   // correct but benign.
246   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
247     return;
248 
249   // Check if this is an inlined function or method.
250   FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl();
251   if (!Current)
252     return;
253   if (!Current->isInlined())
254     return;
255   if (!Current->isExternallyVisible())
256     return;
257 
258   // Check if the decl has internal linkage.
259   if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage)
260     return;
261 
262   // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if
263   //  (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file,
264   //      and probably won't be included anywhere else.
265   //  (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function.
266   //  (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function.
267   // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on
268   // wrappers for simple C library functions.
269   const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
270   bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc);
271   if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn)
272     DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>();
273 
274   S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet
275                                : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline)
276     << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D;
277 
278   S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current);
279 
280   S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
281       << D;
282 }
283 
284 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) {
285   const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl();
286 
287   // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible.
288   if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) {
289     SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin();
290     Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static)
291       << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static ");
292   }
293 }
294 
295 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
296 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
297 ///
298 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
299 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
300 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
301 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
302 /// function is being used.
303 ///
304 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
305 /// referenced), false otherwise.
306 ///
307 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
308                              const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
309                              bool ObjCPropertyAccess) {
310   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
311     // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
312     // emit them now.
313     SuppressedDiagnosticsMap::iterator
314       Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
315     if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
316       SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
317       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
318         Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
319 
320       // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
321       // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this
322       // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
323       // diagnostics again.
324       Suppressed.clear();
325     }
326 
327     // C++ [basic.start.main]p3:
328     //   The function 'main' shall not be used within a program.
329     if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain())
330       Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used);
331   }
332 
333   // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
334   if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) {
335     Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
336       << D->getDeclName();
337     return true;
338   }
339 
340   // See if this is a deleted function.
341   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
342     if (FD->isDeleted()) {
343       Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
344       NoteDeletedFunction(FD);
345       return true;
346     }
347 
348     // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
349     // then we can't use it either.
350     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
351         DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc))
352       return true;
353   }
354   DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this, D, Loc, UnknownObjCClass,
355                              ObjCPropertyAccess);
356 
357   DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc);
358 
359   diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc);
360 
361   return false;
362 }
363 
364 /// \brief Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a
365 /// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or
366 /// unavailable.
367 std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
368   std::string Message;
369   if (FD->getAvailability(&Message))
370     return ": " + Message;
371 
372   return std::string();
373 }
374 
375 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or
376 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and
377 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are
378 /// satisfied.
379 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
380                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
381   const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
382   if (!attr)
383     return;
384 
385   // The number of formal parameters of the declaration.
386   unsigned numFormalParams;
387 
388   // The kind of declaration.  This is also an index into a %select in
389   // the diagnostic.
390   enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType;
391 
392   if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
393     numFormalParams = MD->param_size();
394     calleeType = CT_Method;
395   } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
396     numFormalParams = FD->param_size();
397     calleeType = CT_Function;
398   } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
399     QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType();
400     const FunctionType *fn = nullptr;
401     if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
402       fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
403       if (!fn) return;
404       calleeType = CT_Function;
405     } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
406       fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
407       calleeType = CT_Block;
408     } else {
409       return;
410     }
411 
412     if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) {
413       numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams();
414     } else {
415       numFormalParams = 0;
416     }
417   } else {
418     return;
419   }
420 
421   // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which
422   // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments.  This is
423   // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters,
424   // but the language forces you to have at least one.
425   unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
426   assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel");
427   numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos);
428 
429   // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel.
430   unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel();
431 
432   // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters,
433   // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain.
434   if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) {
435     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
436     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
437     return;
438   }
439 
440   // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression.
441   Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1];
442   if (!sentinelExpr) return;
443   if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
444   if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return;
445 
446   // Pick a reasonable string to insert.  Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr',
447   // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context.  Only use
448   // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the
449   // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers.
450   SourceLocation MissingNilLoc
451     = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd());
452   std::string NullValue;
453   if (calleeType == CT_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil"))
454     NullValue = "nil";
455   else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
456     NullValue = "nullptr";
457   else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL"))
458     NullValue = "NULL";
459   else
460     NullValue = "(void*) 0";
461 
462   if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid())
463     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType);
464   else
465     Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel)
466       << int(calleeType)
467       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue);
468   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
469 }
470 
471 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const {
472   return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
473 }
474 
475 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
476 //  Standard Promotions and Conversions
477 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
478 
479 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
480 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E) {
481   // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
482   if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
483     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
484     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
485     E = result.get();
486   }
487 
488   QualType Ty = E->getType();
489   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
490 
491   if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
492     // If we are here, we are not calling a function but taking
493     // its address (which is not allowed in OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3).
494     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
495       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address);
496       return ExprError();
497     }
498     E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
499                           CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
500   } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
501     // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
502     // an lvalue.  The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
503     // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
504     // to type'...".  In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
505     // that has type 'array of type' ...".  The relevant change is "an lvalue"
506     // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
507     //
508     // C++ 4.2p1:
509     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
510     // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
511     //
512     if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue())
513       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
514                             CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
515   }
516   return E;
517 }
518 
519 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
520   // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer.  If so,
521   // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
522   // optimizer will delete, so warn about it.  People sometimes try to use this
523   // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior.  This
524   // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check.
525   if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
526     if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
527         UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
528           isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
529         !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
530     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
531                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
532                             << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange());
533     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
534                         S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null));
535   }
536 }
537 
538 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE,
539                                     SourceLocation AssignLoc,
540                                     const Expr* RHS) {
541   const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl();
542   if (!IV)
543     return;
544 
545   DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName();
546   IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
547   if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa"))
548     return;
549 
550   const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase();
551   QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
552   if (OIRE->isArrow())
553     BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType();
554   if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
555     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) {
556       ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr;
557       ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
558       if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass()
559           && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) {
560         if (RHS) {
561           NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass =
562             S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
563                                &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
564                                SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
565           if (ObjectSetClass) {
566             SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getLocEnd());
567             S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) <<
568             FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") <<
569             FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(),
570                                                      AssignLoc), ",") <<
571             FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
572           }
573           else
574             S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
575         } else {
576           NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass =
577             S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
578                                &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
579                                SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
580           if (ObjectGetClass)
581             S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) <<
582             FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") <<
583             FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
584                                          SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(),
585                                                      OIRE->getLocEnd()), ")");
586           else
587             S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
588         }
589         S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl);
590       }
591     }
592 }
593 
594 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
595   // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
596   if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
597     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
598     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
599     E = result.get();
600   }
601 
602   // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
603   //   A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be
604   //   converted to a prvalue.
605   if (!E->isGLValue()) return E;
606 
607   QualType T = E->getType();
608   assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?");
609 
610   // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of
611   // expressions of certain types in C++.
612   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
613       (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy ||
614        T->isDependentType() ||
615        T->isRecordType()))
616     return E;
617 
618   // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and
619   // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why.  It's
620   // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo
621   // lvalue-to-rvalue at all.  Note that expressions of unqualified
622   // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be.
623   if (T->isVoidType())
624     return E;
625 
626   // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type.
627   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp16 &&
628       T->isHalfType()) {
629     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store)
630       << 0 << T;
631     return ExprError();
632   }
633 
634   CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E);
635   if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
636     NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
637                                      &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
638                                      SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
639     if (ObjectGetClass)
640       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) <<
641         FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") <<
642         FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
643                     SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")");
644     else
645       Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
646   }
647   else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
648             dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
649     DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr);
650 
651   // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
652   //   [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the
653   //   cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
654   //   rvalue is T.
655   //
656   // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
657   //   If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
658   //   version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
659   //   type of the lvalue.
660   if (T.hasQualifiers())
661     T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
662 
663   UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E);
664 
665   // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to
666   // balance that.
667   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
668       E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
669     ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
670 
671   ExprResult Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue, E,
672                                             nullptr, VK_RValue);
673 
674   // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
675   //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
676   //   of the type of the lvalue ...
677   if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) {
678     T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType();
679     Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(),
680                                    nullptr, VK_RValue);
681   }
682 
683   return Res;
684 }
685 
686 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
687   ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
688   if (Res.isInvalid())
689     return ExprError();
690   Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
691   if (Res.isInvalid())
692     return ExprError();
693   return Res;
694 }
695 
696 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion
697 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression.
698 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
699   QualType Ty = E->getType();
700   ExprResult Res = E;
701   // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer
702   // to function type.
703   if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
704     Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
705                             CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
706     if (Res.isInvalid())
707       return ExprError();
708   }
709   Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
710   if (Res.isInvalid())
711     return ExprError();
712   return Res.get();
713 }
714 
715 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
716 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
717 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
718 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
719 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
720 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
721   // First, convert to an r-value.
722   ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
723   if (Res.isInvalid())
724     return ExprError();
725   E = Res.get();
726 
727   QualType Ty = E->getType();
728   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
729 
730   // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
731   if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
732     return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast);
733 
734   // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically
735   // promotable type.
736   if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
737     // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
738     //
739     //   The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
740     //   unsigned int may be used:
741     //     - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
742     //       conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
743     //       and unsigned int.
744     //     - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
745     //
746     //   If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
747     //   value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
748     //   unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
749     //   other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
750 
751     QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E);
752     if (!PTy.isNull()) {
753       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
754       return E;
755     }
756     if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
757       QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
758       E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get();
759       return E;
760     }
761   }
762   return E;
763 }
764 
765 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
766 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16
767 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by
768 /// UsualUnaryConversions().
769 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) {
770   QualType Ty = E->getType();
771   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
772 
773   ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
774   if (Res.isInvalid())
775     return ExprError();
776   E = Res.get();
777 
778   // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to
779   // double.
780   const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
781   if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half ||
782               BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float))
783     E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
784 
785   // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument
786   // promotion, even on class types, but note:
787   //   C++11 [conv.lval]p2:
788   //     When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated
789   //     operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the
790   //     referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue
791   //     has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary
792   //     of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion
793   //     is a prvalue for the temporary.
794   // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in
795   // potentially potentially evaluated contexts.
796   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) {
797     ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization(
798                        InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()),
799                                                 E->getExprLoc(), E);
800     if (Temp.isInvalid())
801       return ExprError();
802     E = Temp.get();
803   }
804 
805   return E;
806 }
807 
808 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression.
809 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed
810 /// when we're in an unevaluated context.
811 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) {
812   if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) {
813     // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
814     //   After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic,
815     //   enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program
816     //   is ill-formed.
817     //
818     // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer
819     // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles
820     // initializer lists as variadic arguments.
821     if (Ty->isVoidType())
822       return VAK_Invalid;
823 
824     if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
825       return VAK_Invalid;
826     return VAK_Valid;
827   }
828 
829   if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context))
830     return VAK_Valid;
831 
832   // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
833   //   Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9)
834   //   having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor,
835   //   or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter,
836   //   is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics.
837   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType())
838     if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
839       if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() &&
840           !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() &&
841           !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
842         return VAK_ValidInCXX11;
843 
844   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType())
845     return VAK_Valid;
846 
847   if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
848     return VAK_Invalid;
849 
850   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
851     return VAK_MSVCUndefined;
852 
853   // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're
854   // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so.
855   return VAK_Undefined;
856 }
857 
858 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) {
859   // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg.
860   const QualType &Ty = E->getType();
861   VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty);
862 
863   // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs.
864   switch (VAK) {
865   case VAK_ValidInCXX11:
866     DiagRuntimeBehavior(
867         E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
868         PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
869           << Ty << CT);
870     // Fall through.
871   case VAK_Valid:
872     if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
873       // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a
874       // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that.
875       DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
876                           PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg)
877                             << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()");
878     }
879     break;
880 
881   case VAK_Undefined:
882   case VAK_MSVCUndefined:
883     DiagRuntimeBehavior(
884         E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
885         PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
886           << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT);
887     break;
888 
889   case VAK_Invalid:
890     if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
891       DiagRuntimeBehavior(
892           E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
893           PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
894             << Ty << CT);
895     else
896       Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg)
897         << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT;
898     break;
899   }
900 }
901 
902 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
903 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type.
904 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT,
905                                                   FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
906   if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
907     // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
908     if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
909         (CT == VariadicMethod ||
910          (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) {
911       E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
912 
913     // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking.
914     } else {
915       ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
916       if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
917         return ExprError();
918       E = ExprRes.get();
919     }
920   }
921 
922   ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E);
923   if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
924     return ExprError();
925   E = ExprRes.get();
926 
927   // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are
928   // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall().
929   if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) {
930     // Turn this into a trap.
931     CXXScopeSpec SS;
932     SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
933     UnqualifiedId Name;
934     Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"),
935                        E->getLocStart());
936     ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc,
937                                           Name, true, false);
938     if (TrapFn.isInvalid())
939       return ExprError();
940 
941     ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(),
942                                     E->getLocStart(), None,
943                                     E->getLocEnd());
944     if (Call.isInvalid())
945       return ExprError();
946 
947     ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma,
948                                   Call.get(), E);
949     if (Comma.isInvalid())
950       return ExprError();
951     return Comma.get();
952   }
953 
954   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
955       RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(),
956                           diag::err_call_incomplete_argument))
957     return ExprError();
958 
959   return E;
960 }
961 
962 /// \brief Converts an integer to complex float type.  Helper function of
963 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
964 ///
965 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is
966 /// successfully converted to the complex type.
967 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr,
968                                                   ExprResult &ComplexExpr,
969                                                   QualType IntTy,
970                                                   QualType ComplexTy,
971                                                   bool SkipCast) {
972   if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true;
973   if (SkipCast) return false;
974   if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
975     QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType();
976     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating);
977     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
978                                   CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
979   } else {
980     assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
981     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
982                                   CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
983   }
984   return false;
985 }
986 
987 /// \brief Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types.  Helper function of
988 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
989 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
990                                              ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
991                                              QualType RHSType,
992                                              bool IsCompAssign) {
993   // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
994   if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
995                                              /*skipCast*/false))
996     return LHSType;
997   if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
998                                              /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign))
999     return RHSType;
1000 
1001   // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
1002   // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
1003   // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
1004   // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
1005   // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
1006   // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
1007   // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
1008   // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
1009   // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
1010   // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
1011 
1012   // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex.
1013   int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1014 
1015   auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType);
1016   auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType);
1017   QualType LHSElementType =
1018       LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType;
1019   QualType RHSElementType =
1020       RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType;
1021 
1022   QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType);
1023   if (Order < 0) {
1024     // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment.
1025     ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType);
1026     if (!IsCompAssign) {
1027       if (LHSComplexType)
1028         LHS =
1029             S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
1030       else
1031         LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
1032     }
1033   } else if (Order > 0) {
1034     // Promote the precision of the RHS.
1035     if (RHSComplexType)
1036       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
1037     else
1038       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
1039   }
1040   return ResultType;
1041 }
1042 
1043 /// \brief Hande arithmetic conversion from integer to float.  Helper function
1044 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
1045 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr,
1046                                            ExprResult &IntExpr,
1047                                            QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy,
1048                                            bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) {
1049   if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
1050     if (ConvertInt)
1051       // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type.
1052       IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy,
1053                                     CK_IntegralToFloating);
1054     return FloatTy;
1055   }
1056 
1057   // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
1058   assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
1059   QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy);
1060 
1061   // _Complex int -> _Complex float
1062   if (ConvertInt)
1063     IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result,
1064                                   CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
1065 
1066   // float -> _Complex float
1067   if (ConvertFloat)
1068     FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result,
1069                                     CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
1070 
1071   return result;
1072 }
1073 
1074 /// \brief Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types.  Helper
1075 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
1076 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1077                                       ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1078                                       QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1079   bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1080   bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1081 
1082   // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
1083   // to the bigger result.
1084   if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
1085     int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1086     if (order > 0) {
1087       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1088       return LHSType;
1089     }
1090 
1091     assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
1092     if (!IsCompAssign)
1093       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1094     return RHSType;
1095   }
1096 
1097   if (LHSFloat)
1098     return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1099                                       /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign,
1100                                       /*convertInt=*/ true);
1101   assert(RHSFloat);
1102   return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
1103                                     /*convertInt=*/ true,
1104                                     /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign);
1105 }
1106 
1107 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType);
1108 
1109 namespace {
1110 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to
1111 /// permit their use as function template parameters.
1112 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1113   return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast);
1114 }
1115 
1116 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1117   return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType),
1118                              CK_IntegralComplexCast);
1119 }
1120 }
1121 
1122 /// \brief Handle integer arithmetic conversions.  Helper function of
1123 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
1124 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast>
1125 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1126                                         ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1127                                         QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1128   // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
1129   int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1130   bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1131   bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1132   if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) {
1133     // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
1134     if (order >= 0) {
1135       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1136       return LHSType;
1137     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1138       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1139     return RHSType;
1140   } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
1141     // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
1142     // signed type, so use the unsigned type
1143     if (RHSSigned) {
1144       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1145       return LHSType;
1146     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1147       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1148     return RHSType;
1149   } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) {
1150     // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
1151     // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
1152     // use the signed type.
1153     if (LHSSigned) {
1154       RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1155       return LHSType;
1156     } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1157       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1158     return RHSType;
1159   } else {
1160     // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
1161     // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
1162     // on most 32-bit systems).  Use the unsigned type corresponding
1163     // to the signed type.
1164     QualType result =
1165       S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType);
1166     RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result);
1167     if (!IsCompAssign)
1168       LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result);
1169     return result;
1170   }
1171 }
1172 
1173 /// \brief Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension.  Helper function
1174 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
1175 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1176                                            ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1177                                            QualType RHSType,
1178                                            bool IsCompAssign) {
1179   const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1180   const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1181 
1182   if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) {
1183     QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1184     QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1185     QualType ScalarType =
1186       handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1187         (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1188 
1189     return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1190   }
1191 
1192   if (LHSComplexInt) {
1193     QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1194     QualType ScalarType =
1195       handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
1196         (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
1197     QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1198     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType,
1199                               CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1200 
1201     return ComplexType;
1202   }
1203 
1204   assert(RHSComplexInt);
1205 
1206   QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1207   QualType ScalarType =
1208     handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1209       (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1210   QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1211 
1212   if (!IsCompAssign)
1213     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType,
1214                               CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1215   return ComplexType;
1216 }
1217 
1218 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
1219 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
1220 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
1221 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
1222 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
1223                                           bool IsCompAssign) {
1224   if (!IsCompAssign) {
1225     LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
1226     if (LHS.isInvalid())
1227       return QualType();
1228   }
1229 
1230   RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
1231   if (RHS.isInvalid())
1232     return QualType();
1233 
1234   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
1235   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
1236   QualType LHSType =
1237     Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
1238   QualType RHSType =
1239     Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
1240 
1241   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS.
1242   if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1243     LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType();
1244 
1245   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1246   if (LHSType == RHSType)
1247     return LHSType;
1248 
1249   // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
1250   // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
1251   if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType())
1252     return QualType();
1253 
1254   // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
1255   QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType;
1256   if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType())
1257     LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType);
1258   QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
1259   if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
1260     LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
1261   if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign)
1262     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
1263 
1264   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1265   if (LHSType == RHSType)
1266     return LHSType;
1267 
1268   // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
1269 
1270   // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
1271   if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType())
1272     return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1273                                         IsCompAssign);
1274 
1275   // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
1276   if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
1277     return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1278                                  IsCompAssign);
1279 
1280   // Handle GCC complex int extension.
1281   if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType())
1282     return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1283                                       IsCompAssign);
1284 
1285   // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
1286   return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
1287            (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
1288 }
1289 
1290 
1291 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1292 //  Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
1293 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1294 
1295 
1296 ExprResult
1297 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
1298                                 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
1299                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1300                                 Expr *ControllingExpr,
1301                                 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes,
1302                                 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) {
1303   unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size();
1304   assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size());
1305 
1306   TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs];
1307   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1308     if (ArgTypes[i])
1309       (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]);
1310     else
1311       Types[i] = nullptr;
1312   }
1313 
1314   ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1315                                              ControllingExpr,
1316                                              llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs),
1317                                              ArgExprs);
1318   delete [] Types;
1319   return ER;
1320 }
1321 
1322 ExprResult
1323 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
1324                                  SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
1325                                  SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1326                                  Expr *ControllingExpr,
1327                                  ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types,
1328                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) {
1329   unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size();
1330   assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size());
1331   if (ControllingExpr->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
1332     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ControllingExpr);
1333     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
1334     ControllingExpr = result.get();
1335   }
1336 
1337   // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are
1338   // likely unintended.
1339   if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() &&
1340       ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
1341     Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(),
1342          diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
1343 
1344   bool TypeErrorFound = false,
1345        IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(),
1346        ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack
1347          = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack();
1348 
1349   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1350     if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1351       ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1352 
1353     if (Types[i]) {
1354       if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1355         ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1356 
1357       if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1358         IsResultDependent = true;
1359       } else {
1360         // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a
1361         // complete object type other than a variably modified type."
1362         unsigned D = 0;
1363         if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType())
1364           D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete;
1365         else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType())
1366           D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject;
1367         else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
1368           D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified;
1369 
1370         if (D != 0) {
1371           Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D)
1372             << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1373             << Types[i]->getType();
1374           TypeErrorFound = true;
1375         }
1376 
1377         // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic
1378         // selection shall specify compatible types."
1379         for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j)
1380           if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() &&
1381               Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(),
1382                                          Types[j]->getType())) {
1383             Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1384                  diag::err_assoc_compatible_types)
1385               << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1386               << Types[j]->getType()
1387               << Types[i]->getType();
1388             Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1389                  diag::note_compat_assoc)
1390               << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1391               << Types[i]->getType();
1392             TypeErrorFound = true;
1393           }
1394       }
1395     }
1396   }
1397   if (TypeErrorFound)
1398     return ExprError();
1399 
1400   // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't
1401   // try to compute the result expression.
1402   if (IsResultDependent)
1403     return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1404         Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1405         ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack);
1406 
1407   SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices;
1408   unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U;
1409   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1410     if (!Types[i])
1411       DefaultIndex = i;
1412     else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(),
1413                                         Types[i]->getType()))
1414       CompatIndices.push_back(i);
1415   }
1416 
1417   // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have
1418   // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic
1419   // association list."
1420   if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) {
1421     // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1422     // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1423     ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1424     Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match)
1425       << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType()
1426       << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size();
1427     for (SmallVectorImpl<unsigned>::iterator I = CompatIndices.begin(),
1428          E = CompatIndices.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1429       Diag(Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1430            diag::note_compat_assoc)
1431         << Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1432         << Types[*I]->getType();
1433     }
1434     return ExprError();
1435   }
1436 
1437   // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association,
1438   // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of
1439   // the types named in its generic association list."
1440   if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) {
1441     // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1442     // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1443     ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1444     Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match)
1445       << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType();
1446     return ExprError();
1447   }
1448 
1449   // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a
1450   // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression,
1451   // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression
1452   // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the
1453   // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association."
1454   unsigned ResultIndex =
1455     CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex;
1456 
1457   return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1458       Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1459       ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex);
1460 }
1461 
1462 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the
1463 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it.
1464 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
1465                                      unsigned Offset) {
1466   return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(),
1467                                         S.getLangOpts());
1468 }
1469 
1470 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up
1471 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it.
1472 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope,
1473                                                  IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix,
1474                                                  SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc,
1475                                                  ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
1476                                                  SourceLocation LitEndLoc) {
1477   assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator");
1478 
1479   QualType ArgTy[2];
1480   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
1481     ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType();
1482     if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType())
1483       ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]);
1484   }
1485 
1486   DeclarationName OpName =
1487     S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
1488   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
1489   OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
1490 
1491   LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
1492   if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()),
1493                               /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false,
1494                               /*AllowStringTemplate*/false) == Sema::LOLR_Error)
1495     return ExprError();
1496 
1497   return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc);
1498 }
1499 
1500 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
1501 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz").  The result string has to handle string
1502 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
1503 /// multiple tokens.  However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
1504 /// string.
1505 ///
1506 ExprResult
1507 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) {
1508   assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!");
1509 
1510   StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP);
1511   if (Literal.hadError)
1512     return ExprError();
1513 
1514   SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
1515   for (unsigned i = 0; i != StringToks.size(); ++i)
1516     StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
1517 
1518   QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy;
1519   StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii;
1520   if (Literal.isWide()) {
1521     CharTy = Context.getWideCharType();
1522     Kind = StringLiteral::Wide;
1523   } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) {
1524     Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8;
1525   } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) {
1526     CharTy = Context.Char16Ty;
1527     Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16;
1528   } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) {
1529     CharTy = Context.Char32Ty;
1530     Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32;
1531   } else if (Literal.isPascal()) {
1532     CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
1533   }
1534 
1535   QualType CharTyConst = CharTy;
1536   // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
1537   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings)
1538     CharTyConst.addConst();
1539 
1540   // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5.  This includes
1541   // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
1542   // strings.
1543   QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(CharTyConst,
1544                                  llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
1545                                  ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1546 
1547   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space.
1548   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
1549     StrTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(StrTy, LangAS::opencl_constant);
1550   }
1551 
1552   // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
1553   StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
1554                                              Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy,
1555                                              &StringTokLocs[0],
1556                                              StringTokLocs.size());
1557   if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
1558     return Lit;
1559 
1560   // We're building a user-defined literal.
1561   IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
1562   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
1563     getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()],
1564                    Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
1565 
1566   // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
1567   if (!UDLScope)
1568     return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl));
1569 
1570   // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
1571   //   operator "" X (str, len)
1572   QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
1573 
1574   DeclarationName OpName =
1575     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
1576   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
1577   OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
1578 
1579   QualType ArgTy[] = {
1580     Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType
1581   };
1582 
1583   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1584   switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy,
1585                                 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false,
1586                                 /*AllowStringTemplate*/true)) {
1587 
1588   case LOLR_Cooked: {
1589     llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars());
1590     IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType,
1591                                                     StringTokLocs[0]);
1592     Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg };
1593 
1594     return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back());
1595   }
1596 
1597   case LOLR_StringTemplate: {
1598     TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
1599 
1600     unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy);
1601     bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
1602     llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
1603 
1604     TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy);
1605     TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy));
1606     ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo));
1607 
1608     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) {
1609       Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I);
1610       TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy);
1611       TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
1612       ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
1613     }
1614     return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(),
1615                                     &ExplicitArgs);
1616   }
1617   case LOLR_Raw:
1618   case LOLR_Template:
1619     llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
1620   case LOLR_Error:
1621     return ExprError();
1622   }
1623   llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
1624 }
1625 
1626 ExprResult
1627 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
1628                        SourceLocation Loc,
1629                        const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
1630   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
1631   return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS);
1632 }
1633 
1634 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a
1635 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture.
1636 ExprResult
1637 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
1638                        const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1639                        const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD,
1640                        const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1641   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
1642     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
1643       if (const FunctionDecl *Callee = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1644         if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Callee)) {
1645           Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target)
1646             << IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) << D->getIdentifier()
1647             << IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller);
1648           Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1649             << D->getIdentifier();
1650           return ExprError();
1651         }
1652       }
1653 
1654   bool RefersToCapturedVariable =
1655       isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
1656       NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc());
1657 
1658   DeclRefExpr *E;
1659   if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
1660     VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec =
1661         cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D);
1662 
1663     E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)
1664                                         : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
1665                             VarSpec->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), D,
1666                             RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo.getLoc(), Ty, VK,
1667                             FoundD, TemplateArgs);
1668   } else {
1669     assert(!TemplateArgs && "No template arguments for non-variable"
1670                             " template specialization references");
1671     E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)
1672                                         : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
1673                             SourceLocation(), D, RefersToCapturedVariable,
1674                             NameInfo, Ty, VK, FoundD);
1675   }
1676 
1677   MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
1678 
1679   if (getLangOpts().ObjCARCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
1680       Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak &&
1681       !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getLocStart()))
1682       recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(E);
1683 
1684   // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member.
1685   FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
1686   if (FD && FD->isBitField())
1687     E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField);
1688 
1689   return E;
1690 }
1691 
1692 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
1693 /// possibly a list of template arguments.
1694 ///
1695 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
1696 /// DecomposeTemplateName.
1697 ///
1698 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
1699 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
1700 /// some way.
1701 void
1702 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id,
1703                              TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
1704                              DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1705                              const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
1706   if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
1707     Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
1708     Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
1709 
1710     ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
1711                                        Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
1712     translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
1713 
1714     TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
1715     SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
1716     NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
1717     TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
1718   } else {
1719     NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
1720     TemplateArgs = nullptr;
1721   }
1722 }
1723 
1724 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(
1725     const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1726     DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
1727     unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) {
1728   DeclContext *Ctx =
1729       SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1730   if (!TC) {
1731     // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1732     // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1733     if (Ctx)
1734       SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx
1735                                                  << SS.getRange();
1736     else
1737       SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo;
1738     return;
1739   }
1740 
1741   std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts());
1742   bool DroppedSpecifier =
1743       TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
1744   unsigned NoteID =
1745       (TC.getCorrectionDecl() && isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(TC.getCorrectionDecl()))
1746           ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
1747           : diag::note_previous_decl;
1748   if (!Ctx)
1749     SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo,
1750                          SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
1751   else
1752     SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1753                                  << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier
1754                                  << SS.getRange(),
1755                          SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
1756 }
1757 
1758 /// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1759 ///
1760 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
1761 bool
1762 Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
1763                           std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,
1764                           TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1765                           ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) {
1766   DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1767 
1768   unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
1769   unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
1770   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1771       Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
1772       Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
1773     diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
1774     diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1775   }
1776 
1777   // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1778   // unqualified lookup.  This is useful when (for example) the
1779   // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1780   // dependent name.
1781   DeclContext *DC = (SS.isEmpty() && !CallsUndergoingInstantiation.empty())
1782     ? CurContext : nullptr;
1783   while (DC) {
1784     if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1785       LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1786 
1787       if (!R.empty()) {
1788         // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1789         R.suppressDiagnostics();
1790 
1791         // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points
1792         // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a
1793         // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check.
1794         bool isDefaultArgument = !ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() &&
1795                               ActiveTemplateInstantiations.back().Kind ==
1796             ActiveTemplateInstantiation::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation;
1797         CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1798         bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1799                           CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1800                           DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument;
1801 
1802 
1803         // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1804         // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1805         // Actually quite difficult!
1806         if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
1807           diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup;
1808         if (isInstance) {
1809           Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1810             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1811           UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1812               CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
1813 
1814           CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod;
1815           if (CurMethod->isDependentContext())
1816             DepMethod = CurMethod;
1817           else if (CurMethod->getTemplatedKind() ==
1818               FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplateSpecialization)
1819             DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurMethod->getPrimaryTemplate()->
1820                 getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl());
1821           else
1822             DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
1823                 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
1824           assert(DepMethod && "No template pattern found");
1825 
1826           QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1827           CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc());
1828           CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1829                                      R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1830           TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1831           if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1832             ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
1833 
1834           CXXScopeSpec SS;
1835           SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
1836           CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1837               CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1838                   Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
1839                   SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
1840                   ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), nullptr,
1841                   R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1842                   ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TList : nullptr);
1843           CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
1844         } else {
1845           Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1846         }
1847 
1848         // Do we really want to note all of these?
1849         for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1850           Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1851 
1852         // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation
1853         // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise
1854         // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an
1855         // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument.
1856         if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) {
1857           Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object);
1858           return true;
1859         }
1860 
1861         // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1862         return false;
1863       }
1864 
1865       R.clear();
1866     }
1867 
1868     // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend
1869     // function definition declared at class scope then we must set
1870     // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent
1871     // class.
1872     if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) &&
1873         cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() &&
1874         DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord())
1875       DC = DC->getLexicalParent();
1876     else
1877       DC = DC->getParent();
1878   }
1879 
1880   // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
1881   TypoCorrection Corrected;
1882   if (S && Out) {
1883     SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc();
1884     assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs &&
1885            "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!");
1886     *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed(
1887         R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, std::move(CCC),
1888         [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) {
1889           emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args,
1890                                         diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest);
1891         },
1892         nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery);
1893     if (*Out)
1894       return true;
1895   } else if (S && (Corrected =
1896                        CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S,
1897                                    &SS, std::move(CCC), CTK_ErrorRecovery))) {
1898     std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
1899     bool DroppedSpecifier =
1900         Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
1901     R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
1902 
1903     bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false;
1904     bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false;
1905     NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl();
1906     if (ND) {
1907       if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
1908         OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(),
1909                                  OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1910         OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
1911         for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(),
1912                                         CDEnd = Corrected.end();
1913              CD != CDEnd; ++CD) {
1914           if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD =
1915                    dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*CD))
1916             AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
1917                 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1918                 Args, OCS);
1919           else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD))
1920             if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0)
1921               AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none),
1922                                    Args, OCS);
1923         }
1924         switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) {
1925         case OR_Success:
1926           ND = Best->Function;
1927           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
1928           break;
1929         default:
1930           // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note.
1931           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
1932           break;
1933         }
1934       }
1935       R.addDecl(ND);
1936       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) {
1937         CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
1938         if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) {
1939           const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType();
1940           Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
1941         }
1942         if (!Record)
1943           Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(
1944               ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext());
1945         R.setNamingClass(Record);
1946       }
1947 
1948       AcceptableWithRecovery =
1949           isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND);
1950       // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1951       // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1952       // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1953       // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1954       // to recover well anyway.
1955       AcceptableWithoutRecovery =
1956           isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND);
1957     } else {
1958       // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
1959       // because we aren't able to recover.
1960       AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true;
1961     }
1962 
1963     if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) {
1964       unsigned NoteID = (Corrected.getCorrectionDecl() &&
1965                          isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()))
1966                             ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
1967                             : diag::note_previous_decl;
1968       if (SS.isEmpty())
1969         diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name,
1970                      PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
1971       else
1972         diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1973                                   << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1974                                   << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(),
1975                      PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
1976 
1977       // Tell the callee whether to try to recover.
1978       return !AcceptableWithRecovery;
1979     }
1980   }
1981   R.clear();
1982 
1983   // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1984   // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1985   if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1986     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1987       << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1988       << SS.getRange();
1989     return true;
1990   }
1991 
1992   // Give up, we can't recover.
1993   Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1994   return true;
1995 }
1996 
1997 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has
1998 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then
1999 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class.  We can only
2000 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts
2001 /// where 'this' is available.  This doesn't precisely match MSVC's
2002 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough.
2003 static Expr *
2004 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context,
2005                                DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2006                                SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
2007                                const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2008   // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or
2009   // contexts where 'this' is available.
2010   QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType();
2011   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
2012   if (!ThisType.isNull())
2013     RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
2014   else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext))
2015     RD = MD->getParent();
2016   if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases())
2017     return nullptr;
2018 
2019   // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class.  If 'this'
2020   // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit.
2021   SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2022   auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base);
2023   DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD;
2024 
2025   if (!ThisType.isNull()) {
2026     DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->");
2027     return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
2028         Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true,
2029         /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc,
2030         /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
2031   }
2032 
2033   // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class.  This will
2034   // perform name lookup during template instantiation.
2035   CXXScopeSpec SS;
2036   auto *NNS =
2037       NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl());
2038   SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc));
2039   return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create(
2040       Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2041       TemplateArgs);
2042 }
2043 
2044 ExprResult
2045 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2046                         SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id,
2047                         bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand,
2048                         std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,
2049                         bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) {
2050   assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
2051          "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
2052   if (SS.isInvalid())
2053     return ExprError();
2054 
2055   TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
2056 
2057   // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
2058   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
2059   const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
2060   DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
2061 
2062   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
2063   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2064   SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2065 
2066   // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
2067   //   An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
2068   //     -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
2069   //        (note: handled after lookup)
2070   //     -- a template-id that is dependent,
2071   //        (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
2072   //     -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
2073   //     -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
2074   //        names a dependent type.
2075   // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
2076   // we need to handle these differently.
2077   bool DependentID = false;
2078   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
2079       Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
2080     DependentID = true;
2081   } else if (SS.isSet()) {
2082     if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) {
2083       if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
2084         return ExprError();
2085     } else {
2086       DependentID = true;
2087     }
2088   }
2089 
2090   if (DependentID)
2091     return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2092                                       IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2093 
2094   // Perform the required lookup.
2095   LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo,
2096                  (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam)
2097                   ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam : LookupOrdinaryName);
2098   if (TemplateArgs) {
2099     // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
2100     // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
2101     // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
2102     // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
2103     // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
2104     bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
2105     LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
2106                        MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
2107 
2108     if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization ||
2109         (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation))
2110       return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2111                                         IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2112   } else {
2113     bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl();
2114     LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
2115 
2116     // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent
2117     // id-expression.
2118     if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
2119       return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2120                                         IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2121 
2122     // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
2123     // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
2124     if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
2125       ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
2126       if (E.isInvalid())
2127         return ExprError();
2128 
2129       if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>())
2130         return Ex;
2131     }
2132   }
2133 
2134   if (R.isAmbiguous())
2135     return ExprError();
2136 
2137   // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90,
2138   // extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
2139   if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2140     NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
2141     if (D) R.addDecl(D);
2142   }
2143 
2144   // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
2145   // argument-dependent lookup.
2146   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
2147 
2148   if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
2149     if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
2150       if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo,
2151                                                    TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs))
2152         return E;
2153     }
2154 
2155     // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly.
2156     if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier)
2157       return ExprError();
2158 
2159     // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
2160     // call, diagnose the problem.
2161     TypoExpr *TE = nullptr;
2162     auto DefaultValidator = llvm::make_unique<CorrectionCandidateCallback>(
2163         II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() : nullptr);
2164     DefaultValidator->IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand;
2165     assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) &&
2166            "Typo correction callback misconfigured");
2167     if (CCC) {
2168       // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is.
2169       CCC->setTypoName(II);
2170       if (SS.isValid())
2171         CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep());
2172     }
2173     if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R,
2174                             CCC ? std::move(CCC) : std::move(DefaultValidator),
2175                             nullptr, None, &TE)) {
2176       if (TE && KeywordReplacement) {
2177         auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE);
2178         auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection();
2179         if (BestTC.isKeyword()) {
2180           auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
2181           if (State.DiagHandler)
2182             State.DiagHandler(BestTC);
2183           KeywordReplacement->startToken();
2184           KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID());
2185           KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II);
2186           KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin());
2187           // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has
2188           // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr).
2189           clearDelayedTypo(TE);
2190           // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a
2191           // valid-but-null ExprResult.
2192           return (Expr*)nullptr;
2193         }
2194         State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream();
2195       }
2196       return TE ? TE : ExprError();
2197     }
2198 
2199     assert(!R.empty() &&
2200            "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
2201 
2202     // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
2203     // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
2204     // reference the ivar.
2205     if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
2206       R.clear();
2207       ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
2208       // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable
2209       // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it.
2210       if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get())
2211         return ExprError();
2212       return E;
2213     }
2214   }
2215 
2216   // This is guaranteed from this point on.
2217   assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
2218 
2219   // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
2220   // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
2221   //   When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
2222   //   syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
2223   //   body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
2224   //   resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
2225   //   member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
2226   //   class member access expression using (*this) as the
2227   //   postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
2228   //
2229   // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
2230   // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
2231   // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
2232   // non-static member function:
2233   //
2234   // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
2235   //   Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
2236   //   [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
2237   //   member function call.
2238   //
2239   // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
2240   // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
2241   // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
2242   // instance method.
2243   if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
2244     bool MightBeImplicitMember;
2245     if (!IsAddressOfOperand)
2246       MightBeImplicitMember = true;
2247     else if (!SS.isEmpty())
2248       MightBeImplicitMember = false;
2249     else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
2250       MightBeImplicitMember = false;
2251     else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
2252       MightBeImplicitMember = true;
2253     else
2254       MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
2255                               isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
2256                               isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
2257 
2258     if (MightBeImplicitMember)
2259       return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
2260                                              R, TemplateArgs);
2261   }
2262 
2263   if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) {
2264 
2265     // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it
2266     // in BuildTemplateIdExpr().
2267     // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration.
2268     if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId &&
2269         Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) {
2270       assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() &&
2271              "There should only be one declaration found.");
2272     }
2273 
2274     return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs);
2275   }
2276 
2277   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
2278 }
2279 
2280 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
2281 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
2282 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
2283 /// this path.
2284 ExprResult
2285 Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2286                                         const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2287                                         bool IsAddressOfOperand,
2288                                         TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) {
2289   DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2290   if (!DC)
2291     return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2292                                      NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2293 
2294   if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
2295     return ExprError();
2296 
2297   LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
2298   LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
2299 
2300   if (R.isAmbiguous())
2301     return ExprError();
2302 
2303   if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
2304     return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2305                                      NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2306 
2307   if (R.empty()) {
2308     Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
2309       << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
2310     return ExprError();
2311   }
2312 
2313   if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) {
2314     // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in
2315     // a dependent context.  If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to
2316     // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode.
2317     unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
2318     if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
2319       DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
2320     SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc();
2321     auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID);
2322     D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString()
2323       << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc());
2324 
2325     // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE
2326     // context.
2327     if (!RecoveryTSI)
2328       return ExprError();
2329 
2330     // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover.
2331     D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename ");
2332 
2333     // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type.
2334     QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
2335     TypeLocBuilder TLB;
2336     TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc());
2337 
2338     QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty);
2339     ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET);
2340     QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
2341     QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
2342 
2343     *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET);
2344 
2345     return ExprEmpty();
2346   }
2347 
2348   // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually
2349   // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in
2350   // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming
2351   // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11.
2352   if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand)
2353     return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS,
2354                                            /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2355                                            R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2356 
2357   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false);
2358 }
2359 
2360 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
2361 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method.  Perform some
2362 /// additional lookup.
2363 ///
2364 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
2365 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
2366 ///
2367 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
2368 ExprResult
2369 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
2370                          IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
2371   SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
2372   ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
2373 
2374   // Check for error condition which is already reported.
2375   if (!CurMethod)
2376     return ExprError();
2377 
2378   // There are two cases to handle here.  1) scoped lookup could have failed,
2379   // in which case we should look for an ivar.  2) scoped lookup could have
2380   // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
2381   // a global variable).  In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
2382   // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
2383 
2384   // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
2385   // ivars.  But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
2386   // ivar, that's an error.
2387   bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
2388 
2389   bool LookForIvars;
2390   if (Lookup.empty())
2391     LookForIvars = true;
2392   else if (IsClassMethod)
2393     LookForIvars = false;
2394   else
2395     LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
2396                     Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
2397   ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
2398   if (LookForIvars) {
2399     IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
2400     ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
2401     ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr;
2402     if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) {
2403       // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
2404       if (IsClassMethod)
2405         return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
2406                          << IV->getDeclName());
2407 
2408       // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
2409       // error node.  The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
2410       if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
2411         return ExprError();
2412 
2413       // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
2414       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
2415         return ExprError();
2416 
2417       // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
2418       if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
2419           !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) &&
2420           !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport)
2421         Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
2422 
2423       // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
2424       // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
2425       IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
2426       UnqualifiedId SelfName;
2427       SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
2428       SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam);
2429       CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
2430       SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
2431       ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc,
2432                                               SelfName, false, false);
2433       if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
2434         return ExprError();
2435 
2436       SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get());
2437       if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
2438         return ExprError();
2439 
2440       MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true);
2441 
2442       ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily();
2443       if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize &&
2444           !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV))
2445         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
2446 
2447       ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context)
2448           ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc, IV->getLocation(),
2449                           SelfExpr.get(), true, true);
2450 
2451       if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2452         if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) {
2453           if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc))
2454             recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(Result);
2455         }
2456         if (CurContext->isClosure())
2457           Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self)
2458             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "self->");
2459       }
2460 
2461       return Result;
2462     }
2463   } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
2464     // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
2465     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) {
2466       ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
2467       if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
2468         if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
2469             declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared))
2470           Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
2471       }
2472     }
2473   } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
2474              Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) {
2475     // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error.
2476     if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl()))
2477       return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
2478                        << IV->getDeclName());
2479   }
2480 
2481   if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
2482     // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
2483     if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
2484       if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2485             Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
2486         NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
2487                                            S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
2488                                            Lookup.getNameLoc());
2489         if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
2490       }
2491     }
2492   }
2493   // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
2494   return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr);
2495 }
2496 
2497 /// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
2498 ///
2499 /// Logically this happens in three phases:
2500 ///
2501 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
2502 ///   The naming class is the class into which we were looking
2503 ///   when we found the member;  it's the qualifier type if a
2504 ///   qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
2505 ///
2506 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
2507 ///   If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
2508 ///   a using declaration, this is that class;  otherwise it's
2509 ///   the class declaring the member.
2510 ///
2511 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
2512 ///   declaring class of the member.  This conversion does not
2513 ///   obey access control.
2514 ExprResult
2515 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From,
2516                                     NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
2517                                     NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
2518                                     NamedDecl *Member) {
2519   CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
2520   if (!RD)
2521     return From;
2522 
2523   QualType DestRecordType;
2524   QualType DestType;
2525   QualType FromRecordType;
2526   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2527   bool PointerConversions = false;
2528   if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
2529     DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
2530 
2531     if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2532       DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
2533       FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2534       PointerConversions = true;
2535     } else {
2536       DestType = DestRecordType;
2537       FromRecordType = FromType;
2538     }
2539   } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
2540     if (Method->isStatic())
2541       return From;
2542 
2543     DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
2544     DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
2545 
2546     if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2547       FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2548       PointerConversions = true;
2549     } else {
2550       FromRecordType = FromType;
2551       DestType = DestRecordType;
2552     }
2553   } else {
2554     // No conversion necessary.
2555     return From;
2556   }
2557 
2558   if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
2559     return From;
2560 
2561   // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
2562   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
2563     return From;
2564 
2565   SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
2566   SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
2567 
2568   ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind();
2569 
2570   // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
2571   //   [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
2572   //   class name.
2573   //
2574   // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
2575   // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
2576   // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
2577   // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
2578   //
2579   //   class Base { public: int x; };
2580   //   class Derived1 : public Base { };
2581   //   class Derived2 : public Base { };
2582   //   class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
2583   //
2584   //   void VeryDerived::f() {
2585   //     x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
2586   //     Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
2587   //   }
2588   if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) {
2589     QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
2590     assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
2591 
2592     QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
2593 
2594     // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
2595     // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
2596     // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
2597     if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
2598       CXXCastPath BasePath;
2599       if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
2600                                        FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
2601         return ExprError();
2602 
2603       if (PointerConversions)
2604         QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
2605       From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2606                                VK, &BasePath).get();
2607 
2608       FromType = QType;
2609       FromRecordType = QRecordType;
2610 
2611       // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
2612       // we're done.
2613       if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
2614         return From;
2615     }
2616   }
2617 
2618   bool IgnoreAccess = false;
2619 
2620   // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
2621   // down to the using declaration's type.
2622   //
2623   // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
2624   // class ever has member declarations.
2625   if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
2626     assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
2627     QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
2628                            cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
2629 
2630     // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
2631     // conversion is non-trivial.
2632     if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
2633       assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
2634       CXXCastPath BasePath;
2635       if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
2636                                        FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
2637         return ExprError();
2638 
2639       QualType UType = URecordType;
2640       if (PointerConversions)
2641         UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
2642       From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2643                                VK, &BasePath).get();
2644       FromType = UType;
2645       FromRecordType = URecordType;
2646     }
2647 
2648     // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
2649     // declaring class to the true declaring class.
2650     IgnoreAccess = true;
2651   }
2652 
2653   CXXCastPath BasePath;
2654   if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
2655                                    FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
2656                                    IgnoreAccess))
2657     return ExprError();
2658 
2659   return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2660                            VK, &BasePath);
2661 }
2662 
2663 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2664                                       const LookupResult &R,
2665                                       bool HasTrailingLParen) {
2666   // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
2667   if (!HasTrailingLParen)
2668     return false;
2669 
2670   // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
2671   if (SS.isSet())
2672     return false;
2673 
2674   // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
2675   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
2676     return false;
2677 
2678   // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
2679   // normal lookup:
2680   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
2681     NamedDecl *D = *I;
2682 
2683     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2684     //     -- a declaration of a class member
2685     // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
2686     // original decl.
2687     if (D->isCXXClassMember())
2688       return false;
2689 
2690     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2691     //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
2692     //        using-declaration
2693     // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
2694     // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
2695     // turn off ADL anyway).
2696     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2697       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2698     else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2699       return false;
2700 
2701     // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2702     //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2703     //        template
2704     // And also for builtin functions.
2705     if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2706       FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2707 
2708       // But also builtin functions.
2709       if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2710         return false;
2711     } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2712       return false;
2713   }
2714 
2715   return true;
2716 }
2717 
2718 
2719 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2720 /// as an expression.  This is only actually called for lookups that
2721 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2722 /// will in fact be used.
2723 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
2724   if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
2725     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2726     return true;
2727   }
2728 
2729   if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2730     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2731     return true;
2732   }
2733 
2734   if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2735     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2736     return true;
2737   }
2738 
2739   return false;
2740 }
2741 
2742 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2743                                           LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL,
2744                                           bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
2745   // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2746   // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
2747   if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
2748     return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(),
2749                                     R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr,
2750                                     AcceptInvalidDecl);
2751 
2752   // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2753   // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2754   // functions and function templates.
2755   if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2756       CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
2757     return ExprError();
2758 
2759   // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression.  Suppress
2760   // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2761   // we've picked a target.
2762   R.suppressDiagnostics();
2763 
2764   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
2765     = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(),
2766                                    SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
2767                                    R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2768                                    NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2769                                    R.begin(), R.end());
2770 
2771   return ULE;
2772 }
2773 
2774 /// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
2775 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(
2776     const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D,
2777     NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2778     bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
2779   assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
2780   assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2781          "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
2782 
2783   SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2784   if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2785     return ExprError();
2786 
2787   if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2788     // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2789     // a template argument list.
2790     Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref) << (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(D) ? 1 : 0)
2791                                            << Template << SS.getRange();
2792     Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2793     return ExprError();
2794   }
2795 
2796   // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2797   ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2798   if (!VD) {
2799     Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
2800       << D << SS.getRange();
2801     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2802     return ExprError();
2803   }
2804 
2805   // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2806   // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2807   // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2808   // that overload resolution actually selects.
2809   if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
2810     return ExprError();
2811 
2812   // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2813   if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl)
2814     return ExprError();
2815 
2816   // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions.  If we got here,
2817   // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this
2818   // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression.
2819   if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
2820     if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember())
2821       return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(),
2822                                                       indirectField);
2823 
2824   {
2825     QualType type = VD->getType();
2826     ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue;
2827 
2828     switch (D->getKind()) {
2829     // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds.
2830 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind)
2831 #define VALUE(type, base)
2832 #define DECL(type, base) \
2833     case Decl::type:
2834 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc"
2835       llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind");
2836 
2837     // These shouldn't make it here.
2838     case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
2839     case Decl::ObjCIvar:
2840       llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?");
2841 
2842     // Enum constants are always r-values and never references.
2843     // Unresolved using declarations are dependent.
2844     case Decl::EnumConstant:
2845     case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
2846       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2847       break;
2848 
2849     // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for
2850     // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for
2851     // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really
2852     // exist in the high-level semantics.
2853     case Decl::Field:
2854     case Decl::IndirectField:
2855       assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2856              "building reference to field in C?");
2857 
2858       // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but
2859       // for internal consistency we do this anyway.
2860       type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2861       valueKind = VK_LValue;
2862       break;
2863 
2864     // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values
2865     // depending on the type.
2866     case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: {
2867       if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
2868         type = reftype->getPointeeType();
2869         valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference
2870         break;
2871       }
2872 
2873       // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case
2874       // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever.
2875       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2876       type = type.getUnqualifiedType();
2877       break;
2878     }
2879 
2880     case Decl::Var:
2881     case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization:
2882     case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization:
2883       // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value.
2884       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2885           !type.hasQualifiers() &&
2886           type->isVoidType()) {
2887         valueKind = VK_RValue;
2888         break;
2889       }
2890       // fallthrough
2891 
2892     case Decl::ImplicitParam:
2893     case Decl::ParmVar: {
2894       // These are always l-values.
2895       valueKind = VK_LValue;
2896       type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2897 
2898       // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in
2899       // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually
2900       // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no.
2901       if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) {
2902         QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc);
2903         if (!CapturedType.isNull())
2904           type = CapturedType;
2905       }
2906 
2907       break;
2908     }
2909 
2910     case Decl::Function: {
2911       if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) {
2912         if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) {
2913           type = Context.BuiltinFnTy;
2914           valueKind = VK_RValue;
2915           break;
2916         }
2917       }
2918 
2919       const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>();
2920 
2921       // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype
2922       // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2923       if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2924         type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2925         valueKind = VK_RValue;
2926         break;
2927       }
2928 
2929       // Functions are l-values in C++.
2930       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2931         valueKind = VK_LValue;
2932         break;
2933       }
2934 
2935       // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
2936       // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
2937       // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
2938       // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
2939       // type.
2940       if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() &&
2941           isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty))
2942         type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(),
2943                                               fty->getExtInfo());
2944 
2945       // Functions are r-values in C.
2946       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2947       break;
2948     }
2949 
2950     case Decl::MSProperty:
2951       valueKind = VK_LValue;
2952       break;
2953 
2954     case Decl::CXXMethod:
2955       // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype
2956       // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2957       // This should only be possible with a type written directly.
2958       if (const FunctionProtoType *proto
2959             = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType()))
2960         if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2961           type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2962           valueKind = VK_RValue;
2963           break;
2964         }
2965 
2966       // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static.
2967       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) {
2968         valueKind = VK_LValue;
2969         break;
2970       }
2971       // fallthrough
2972 
2973     case Decl::CXXConversion:
2974     case Decl::CXXDestructor:
2975     case Decl::CXXConstructor:
2976       valueKind = VK_RValue;
2977       break;
2978     }
2979 
2980     return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD,
2981                             TemplateArgs);
2982   }
2983 }
2984 
2985 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source,
2986                                     SmallString<32> &Target) {
2987   Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1));
2988   char *ResultPtr = &Target[0];
2989   const UTF8 *ErrorPtr;
2990   bool success = ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr);
2991   (void)success;
2992   assert(success);
2993   Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]);
2994 }
2995 
2996 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
2997                                      PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT) {
2998   // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function.
2999   Decl *currentDecl = nullptr;
3000   if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock())
3001     currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl;
3002   else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda())
3003     currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator;
3004   else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion())
3005     currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl;
3006   else
3007     currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
3008 
3009   if (!currentDecl) {
3010     Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
3011     currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
3012   }
3013 
3014   QualType ResTy;
3015   StringLiteral *SL = nullptr;
3016   if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext())
3017     ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
3018   else {
3019     // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of
3020     // the string.
3021     auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl);
3022     unsigned Length = Str.length();
3023 
3024     llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
3025     if (IT == PredefinedExpr::LFunction) {
3026       ResTy = Context.WideCharTy.withConst();
3027       SmallString<32> RawChars;
3028       ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(),
3029                               Str, RawChars);
3030       ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal,
3031                                            /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
3032       SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide,
3033                                  /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
3034     } else {
3035       ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
3036       ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal,
3037                                            /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
3038       SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii,
3039                                  /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
3040     }
3041   }
3042 
3043   return new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT, SL);
3044 }
3045 
3046 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
3047   PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
3048 
3049   switch (Kind) {
3050   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!");
3051   case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
3052   case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
3053   case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS]
3054   case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS]
3055   case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break;
3056   case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
3057   }
3058 
3059   return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IT);
3060 }
3061 
3062 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3063   SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
3064   bool Invalid = false;
3065   StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
3066   if (Invalid)
3067     return ExprError();
3068 
3069   CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
3070                             PP, Tok.getKind());
3071   if (Literal.hadError())
3072     return ExprError();
3073 
3074   QualType Ty;
3075   if (Literal.isWide())
3076     Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++.
3077   else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3078     Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11.
3079   else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3080     Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11.
3081   else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar())
3082     Ty = Context.IntTy;   // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
3083   else
3084     Ty = Context.CharTy;  // 'x' -> char in C++
3085 
3086   CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii;
3087   if (Literal.isWide())
3088     Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide;
3089   else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3090     Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16;
3091   else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3092     Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32;
3093 
3094   Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty,
3095                                              Tok.getLocation());
3096 
3097   if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
3098     return Lit;
3099 
3100   // We're building a user-defined literal.
3101   IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3102   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3103     getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3104 
3105   // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3106   if (!UDLScope)
3107     return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl));
3108 
3109   // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
3110   //   operator "" X (ch)
3111   return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc,
3112                                         Lit, Tok.getLocation());
3113 }
3114 
3115 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) {
3116   unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
3117   return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val),
3118                                 Context.IntTy, Loc);
3119 }
3120 
3121 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal,
3122                                   QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) {
3123   const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
3124 
3125   using llvm::APFloat;
3126   APFloat Val(Format);
3127 
3128   APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
3129 
3130   // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
3131   // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
3132   if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
3133       ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
3134     unsigned diagnostic;
3135     SmallString<20> buffer;
3136     if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
3137       diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
3138       APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
3139     } else {
3140       diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
3141       APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
3142     }
3143 
3144     S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic)
3145       << Ty
3146       << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
3147   }
3148 
3149   bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
3150   return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc);
3151 }
3152 
3153 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
3154   assert(E && "Invalid expression");
3155 
3156   if (E->isValueDependent())
3157     return false;
3158 
3159   QualType QT = E->getType();
3160   if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) {
3161     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT;
3162     return true;
3163   }
3164 
3165   llvm::APSInt ValueAPS;
3166   ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS);
3167 
3168   if (R.isInvalid())
3169     return true;
3170 
3171   bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive();
3172   if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) {
3173     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value)
3174         << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive;
3175     return true;
3176   }
3177 
3178   return false;
3179 }
3180 
3181 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3182   // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common).  A single digit
3183   // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix.
3184   if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
3185     const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
3186     return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0');
3187   }
3188 
3189   SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer;
3190   // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character.  Add padding to
3191   // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer.  If getSpelling()
3192   // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at
3193   // the EOF, so it is also safe.
3194   SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1);
3195 
3196   // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
3197   bool Invalid = false;
3198   StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid);
3199   if (Invalid)
3200     return ExprError();
3201 
3202   NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP);
3203   if (Literal.hadError)
3204     return ExprError();
3205 
3206   if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) {
3207     // We're building a user-defined literal.
3208     IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3209     SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3210       getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3211 
3212     // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3213     if (!UDLScope)
3214       return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl));
3215 
3216     QualType CookedTy;
3217     if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3218       // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3219       // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3220       //   operator "" X (f L)
3221       CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy;
3222     } else {
3223       // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3224       // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3225       //   operator "" X (n ULL)
3226       CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3227     }
3228 
3229     DeclarationName OpName =
3230       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
3231     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
3232     OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
3233 
3234     SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation();
3235 
3236     // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw
3237     // literal or a cooked one.
3238     LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
3239     switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy,
3240                                   /*AllowRaw*/true, /*AllowTemplate*/true,
3241                                   /*AllowStringTemplate*/false)) {
3242     case LOLR_Error:
3243       return ExprError();
3244 
3245     case LOLR_Cooked: {
3246       Expr *Lit;
3247       if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3248         Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation());
3249       } else {
3250         llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0);
3251         if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal))
3252           Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3253               << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3254         Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy,
3255                                      Tok.getLocation());
3256       }
3257       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3258     }
3259 
3260     case LOLR_Raw: {
3261       // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the
3262       // literal is treated as a call of the form
3263       //   operator "" X ("n")
3264       unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset();
3265       QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(
3266           Context.CharTy.withConst(), llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1),
3267           ArrayType::Normal, 0);
3268       Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(
3269           Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii,
3270           /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1);
3271       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3272     }
3273 
3274     case LOLR_Template: {
3275       // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator
3276       // template), L is treated as a call fo the form
3277       //   operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>()
3278       // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck.
3279       TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
3280       unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy);
3281       bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
3282       llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
3283       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) {
3284         Value = TokSpelling[I];
3285         TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy);
3286         TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
3287         ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
3288       }
3289       return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc,
3290                                       &ExplicitArgs);
3291     }
3292     case LOLR_StringTemplate:
3293       llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
3294     }
3295   }
3296 
3297   Expr *Res;
3298 
3299   if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3300     QualType Ty;
3301     if (Literal.isFloat)
3302       Ty = Context.FloatTy;
3303     else if (!Literal.isLong)
3304       Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
3305     else
3306       Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
3307 
3308     Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
3309 
3310     if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) {
3311       if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) {
3312         Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3313       } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
3314                  !((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) ||
3315                    getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp64)) {
3316         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64);
3317         Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3318       }
3319     }
3320   } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
3321     return ExprError();
3322   } else {
3323     QualType Ty;
3324 
3325     // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature.
3326     if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) {
3327       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
3328         Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
3329              getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ?
3330              diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong);
3331       else
3332         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong);
3333     }
3334 
3335     // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
3336     unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth();
3337     // The microsoft literal suffix extensions support 128-bit literals, which
3338     // may be wider than [u]intmax_t.
3339     // FIXME: Actually, they don't. We seem to have accidentally invented the
3340     //        i128 suffix.
3341     if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 128 && MaxWidth < 128 &&
3342         Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
3343       MaxWidth = 128;
3344     llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0);
3345 
3346     if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
3347       // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull.
3348       Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3349           << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3350       Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3351       assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
3352              "long long is not intmax_t?");
3353     } else {
3354       // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
3355       // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
3356 
3357       // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
3358       // be an unsigned int.
3359       bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
3360 
3361       // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
3362       unsigned Width = 0;
3363 
3364       // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized.
3365       if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) {
3366         if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger > MaxWidth) {
3367           // If this target doesn't support __int128, error and force to ull.
3368           Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_int128_unsupported);
3369           Width = MaxWidth;
3370           Ty = Context.getIntMaxType();
3371         } else if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) {
3372           Width = 8;
3373           Ty = Context.CharTy;
3374         } else {
3375           Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger;
3376           Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width,
3377                                              /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned);
3378         }
3379       }
3380 
3381       if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
3382         // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
3383         unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
3384 
3385         // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
3386         if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
3387           // Does it fit in a signed int?
3388           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
3389             Ty = Context.IntTy;
3390           else if (AllowUnsigned)
3391             Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
3392           Width = IntSize;
3393         }
3394       }
3395 
3396       // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
3397       if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
3398         unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
3399 
3400         // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
3401         if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
3402           // Does it fit in a signed long?
3403           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
3404             Ty = Context.LongTy;
3405           else if (AllowUnsigned)
3406             Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
3407           Width = LongSize;
3408         }
3409       }
3410 
3411       // Check long long if needed.
3412       if (Ty.isNull()) {
3413         unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
3414 
3415         // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
3416         if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
3417           // Does it fit in a signed long long?
3418           // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the
3419           // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode.
3420           if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 ||
3421               (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && Literal.isLongLong)))
3422             Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
3423           else if (AllowUnsigned)
3424             Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3425           Width = LongLongSize;
3426         }
3427       }
3428 
3429       // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
3430       // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
3431       if (Ty.isNull()) {
3432         Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed);
3433         Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3434         Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
3435       }
3436 
3437       if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
3438         ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width);
3439     }
3440     Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
3441   }
3442 
3443   // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
3444   if (Literal.isImaginary)
3445     Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
3446                                         Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
3447 
3448   return Res;
3449 }
3450 
3451 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
3452   assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
3453   return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E);
3454 }
3455 
3456 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
3457                                          SourceLocation Loc,
3458                                          SourceRange ArgRange) {
3459   // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in
3460   // scalar or vector data type argument..."
3461   // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic
3462   // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void.
3463   if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) {
3464     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type)
3465       << T << ArgRange;
3466     return true;
3467   }
3468 
3469   assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) &&
3470          "Scalar types should always be complete");
3471   return false;
3472 }
3473 
3474 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
3475                                            SourceLocation Loc,
3476                                            SourceRange ArgRange,
3477                                            UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
3478   // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++.
3479   if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus)
3480     return true;
3481 
3482   // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
3483   if (T->isFunctionType() &&
3484       (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf)) {
3485     // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
3486     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3487       << TraitKind << ArgRange;
3488     return false;
3489   }
3490 
3491   // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where
3492   // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k)
3493   if (T->isVoidType()) {
3494     unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type
3495                                         : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type;
3496     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange;
3497     return false;
3498   }
3499 
3500   return true;
3501 }
3502 
3503 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T,
3504                                              SourceLocation Loc,
3505                                              SourceRange ArgRange,
3506                                              UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
3507   // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the
3508   // runtime doesn't allow it.
3509   if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) {
3510     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
3511       << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf)
3512       << ArgRange;
3513     return true;
3514   }
3515 
3516   return false;
3517 }
3518 
3519 /// \brief Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed
3520 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is.
3521 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T,
3522                                      Expr *E) {
3523   // Don't warn if the operation changed the type.
3524   if (T != E->getType())
3525     return;
3526 
3527   // Now look for array decays.
3528   ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
3529   if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay)
3530     return;
3531 
3532   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange()
3533                                              << ICE->getType()
3534                                              << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType();
3535 }
3536 
3537 /// \brief Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression
3538 /// and type traits.
3539 ///
3540 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand
3541 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify
3542 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template
3543 /// instantiation, etc.
3544 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E,
3545                                             UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3546   QualType ExprTy = E->getType();
3547   assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
3548 
3549   if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
3550     return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3551                                         E->getSourceRange());
3552 
3553   // Whitelist some types as extensions
3554   if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3555                                       E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
3556     return false;
3557 
3558   // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of
3559   // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to
3560   // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown
3561   // bound).
3562   if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) {
3563     if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(),
3564                             Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()),
3565                             diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind,
3566                             E->getSourceRange()))
3567       return true;
3568   } else {
3569     if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
3570                                 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange()))
3571       return true;
3572   }
3573 
3574   // Completing the expression's type may have changed it.
3575   ExprTy = E->getType();
3576   assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
3577 
3578   if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) {
3579     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3580       << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange();
3581     return true;
3582   }
3583 
3584   // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context,
3585   // so side effects could result in unintended consequences.
3586   if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) &&
3587       ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
3588     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
3589 
3590   if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3591                                        E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
3592     return true;
3593 
3594   if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) {
3595     if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
3596       if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) {
3597         QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType();
3598         QualType Type = PVD->getType();
3599         if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) {
3600           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param)
3601             << Type << OType;
3602           Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
3603         }
3604       }
3605     }
3606 
3607     // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array
3608     // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most
3609     // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x".
3610     if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
3611       warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
3612                                BO->getLHS());
3613       warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
3614                                BO->getRHS());
3615     }
3616   }
3617 
3618   return false;
3619 }
3620 
3621 /// \brief Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type
3622 /// traits.
3623 ///
3624 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints
3625 /// on those operands.
3626 ///
3627 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
3628 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state:
3629 ///   Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ...
3630 ///
3631 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4
3632 ///   The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer
3633 ///   standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof.
3634 ///
3635 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions.
3636 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,
3637                                             SourceLocation OpLoc,
3638                                             SourceRange ExprRange,
3639                                             UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3640   if (ExprType->isDependentType())
3641     return false;
3642 
3643   // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2:
3644   //     When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result
3645   //     is the size of the referenced type.
3646   // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
3647   //     When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result
3648   //     shall be the alignment of the referenced type.
3649   if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
3650     ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
3651 
3652   // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
3653   //   When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result
3654   //   is the alignment of the element type.
3655   if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf)
3656     ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType);
3657 
3658   if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
3659     return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange);
3660 
3661   // Whitelist some types as extensions
3662   if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
3663                                       ExprKind))
3664     return false;
3665 
3666   if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType,
3667                           diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
3668                           ExprKind, ExprRange))
3669     return true;
3670 
3671   if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) {
3672     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3673       << ExprKind << ExprRange;
3674     return true;
3675   }
3676 
3677   if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
3678                                        ExprKind))
3679     return true;
3680 
3681   return false;
3682 }
3683 
3684 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
3685   E = E->IgnoreParens();
3686 
3687   // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
3688   if (E->isTypeDependent())
3689     return false;
3690 
3691   if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) {
3692     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield)
3693        << 1 << E->getSourceRange();
3694     return true;
3695   }
3696 
3697   ValueDecl *D = nullptr;
3698   if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
3699     D = DRE->getDecl();
3700   } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
3701     D = ME->getMemberDecl();
3702   }
3703 
3704   // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a
3705   // complete definition so that we can compute the layout.
3706   //
3707   // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member
3708   // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression
3709   // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member
3710   // in a trailing-return-type.
3711   //
3712   // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC
3713   // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the
3714   // nonsensical answer 0.
3715   //
3716   // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just
3717   // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing
3718   // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of
3719   // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal
3720   // use-case.
3721   if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) {
3722     // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a
3723     // definition if we can find a member of it.
3724     if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) {
3725       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type)
3726         << E->getSourceRange();
3727       return true;
3728     }
3729 
3730     // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have
3731     // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a
3732     // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to
3733     // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial.
3734     if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
3735       return false;
3736   }
3737 
3738   return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf);
3739 }
3740 
3741 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) {
3742   E = E->IgnoreParens();
3743 
3744   // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
3745   if (E->isTypeDependent())
3746     return false;
3747 
3748   return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep);
3749 }
3750 
3751 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
3752 ExprResult
3753 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3754                                      SourceLocation OpLoc,
3755                                      UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
3756                                      SourceRange R) {
3757   if (!TInfo)
3758     return ExprError();
3759 
3760   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
3761 
3762   if (!T->isDependentType() &&
3763       CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind))
3764     return ExprError();
3765 
3766   // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
3767   return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
3768       ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd());
3769 }
3770 
3771 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
3772 /// operand.
3773 ExprResult
3774 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
3775                                      UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3776   ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
3777   if (PE.isInvalid())
3778     return ExprError();
3779 
3780   E = PE.get();
3781 
3782   // Verify that the operand is valid.
3783   bool isInvalid = false;
3784   if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
3785     // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
3786   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) {
3787     isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E);
3788   } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) {
3789     isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E);
3790   } else if (E->refersToBitField()) {  // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
3791     Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
3792     isInvalid = true;
3793   } else {
3794     isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf);
3795   }
3796 
3797   if (isInvalid)
3798     return ExprError();
3799 
3800   if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) {
3801     PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
3802     if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3803     E = PE.get();
3804   }
3805 
3806   // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
3807   return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
3808       ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
3809 }
3810 
3811 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c
3812 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
3813 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
3814 ExprResult
3815 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,
3816                                     UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType,
3817                                     void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
3818   // If error parsing type, ignore.
3819   if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError();
3820 
3821   if (IsType) {
3822     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3823     (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
3824     return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange);
3825   }
3826 
3827   Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
3828   ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind);
3829   return Result;
3830 }
3831 
3832 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc,
3833                                      bool IsReal) {
3834   if (V.get()->isTypeDependent())
3835     return S.Context.DependentTy;
3836 
3837   // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values.
3838   if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) {
3839     V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get());
3840     if (V.isInvalid())
3841       return QualType();
3842   }
3843 
3844   // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
3845   if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
3846     return CT->getElementType();
3847 
3848   // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
3849   if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType())
3850     return V.get()->getType();
3851 
3852   // Test for placeholders.
3853   ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get());
3854   if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
3855   if (PR.get() != V.get()) {
3856     V = PR;
3857     return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal);
3858   }
3859 
3860   // Reject anything else.
3861   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType()
3862     << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
3863   return QualType();
3864 }
3865 
3866 
3867 
3868 ExprResult
3869 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
3870                           tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
3871   UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
3872   switch (Kind) {
3873   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
3874   case tok::plusplus:   Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
3875   case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
3876   }
3877 
3878   // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3879   ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input);
3880   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3881   Input = Result.get();
3882 
3883   return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
3884 }
3885 
3886 /// \brief Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal.
3887 ///
3888 /// \return true on error
3889 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S,
3890                                          SourceLocation opLoc,
3891                                          Expr *op) {
3892   assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType());
3893   if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() &&
3894       !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime)
3895     return false;
3896 
3897   S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
3898     << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3899     << op->getSourceRange();
3900   return true;
3901 }
3902 
3903 ExprResult
3904 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc,
3905                               Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) {
3906   // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3907   if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) {
3908     ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base);
3909     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3910     base = result.get();
3911   }
3912 
3913   // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index
3914   // expressions.  We can't handle overloads here because the other
3915   // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload
3916   // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack
3917   // at the overload.
3918   if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
3919     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base);
3920     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3921     base = result.get();
3922   }
3923   if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
3924     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx);
3925     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3926     idx = result.get();
3927   }
3928 
3929   // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent.
3930   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3931       (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) {
3932     return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy,
3933                                             VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc);
3934   }
3935 
3936   // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record
3937   // type.  The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*,
3938   // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion
3939   // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution
3940   // to do if there aren't any record types involved.
3941   //
3942   // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied
3943   // to overload resolution and so should not take this path.
3944   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3945       (base->getType()->isRecordType() ||
3946        (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
3947         idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) {
3948     return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx);
3949   }
3950 
3951   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc);
3952 }
3953 
3954 ExprResult
3955 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
3956                                       Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
3957   Expr *LHSExp = Base;
3958   Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
3959 
3960   // Perform default conversions.
3961   if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) {
3962     ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
3963     if (Result.isInvalid())
3964       return ExprError();
3965     LHSExp = Result.get();
3966   }
3967   ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
3968   if (Result.isInvalid())
3969     return ExprError();
3970   RHSExp = Result.get();
3971 
3972   QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
3973   ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
3974   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
3975 
3976   // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
3977   // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
3978   // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
3979   // and index from the expression types.
3980   Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
3981   QualType ResultType;
3982   if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
3983     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3984     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3985     ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
3986   } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3987     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3988     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3989     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
3990   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
3991                LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3992     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
3993     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
3994 
3995     // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript
3996     // expression.
3997     if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic())
3998       return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr,
3999                                           nullptr);
4000 
4001     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
4002   } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4003      // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
4004     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
4005     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
4006     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
4007   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
4008                RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4009      // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
4010     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
4011     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
4012     ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
4013     if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) {
4014       Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
4015         << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4016       return ExprError();
4017     }
4018   } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4019     BaseExpr = LHSExp;    // vectors: V[123]
4020     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
4021     VK = LHSExp->getValueKind();
4022     if (VK != VK_RValue)
4023       OK = OK_VectorComponent;
4024 
4025     // FIXME: need to deal with const...
4026     ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
4027   } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
4028     // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
4029     // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
4030     // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
4031     // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays.  Warn, then
4032     // force the promotion here.
4033     Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
4034         LHSExp->getSourceRange();
4035     LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
4036                                CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
4037     LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
4038 
4039     BaseExpr = LHSExp;
4040     IndexExpr = RHSExp;
4041     ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4042   } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
4043     // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
4044     Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
4045         RHSExp->getSourceRange();
4046     RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
4047                                CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
4048     RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
4049 
4050     BaseExpr = RHSExp;
4051     IndexExpr = LHSExp;
4052     ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4053   } else {
4054     return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
4055        << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
4056   }
4057   // C99 6.5.2.1p1
4058   if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
4059     return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
4060                      << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
4061 
4062   if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
4063        IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
4064          && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
4065     Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
4066 
4067   // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
4068   // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
4069   // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
4070   // incomplete types are not object types.
4071   if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
4072     Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
4073       << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4074     return ExprError();
4075   }
4076 
4077   if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4078     // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
4079     Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type)
4080       << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4081 
4082     // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values.
4083     // See IsCForbiddenLValueType.
4084     if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue;
4085   } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
4086       RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
4087                           diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr))
4088     return ExprError();
4089 
4090   assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus ||
4091          !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType());
4092 
4093   return new (Context)
4094       ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc);
4095 }
4096 
4097 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
4098                                         FunctionDecl *FD,
4099                                         ParmVarDecl *Param) {
4100   if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
4101     Diag(CallLoc,
4102          diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
4103       FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
4104     Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
4105          diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
4106     return ExprError();
4107   }
4108 
4109   if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
4110     Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
4111 
4112     EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(*this, PotentiallyEvaluated,
4113                                                  Param);
4114 
4115     // Instantiate the expression.
4116     MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList
4117       = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
4118 
4119     InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
4120                                MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost());
4121     if (Inst.isInvalid())
4122       return ExprError();
4123 
4124     ExprResult Result;
4125     {
4126       // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5:
4127       //   The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and
4128       //   the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the
4129       //   default argument expression appears.
4130       ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD);
4131       LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this);
4132       Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList);
4133     }
4134     if (Result.isInvalid())
4135       return ExprError();
4136 
4137     // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
4138     InitializedEntity Entity
4139       = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
4140     InitializationKind Kind
4141       = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
4142              /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getLocStart());
4143     Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>();
4144 
4145     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
4146     Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
4147     if (Result.isInvalid())
4148       return ExprError();
4149 
4150     Expr *Arg = Result.getAs<Expr>();
4151     CheckCompletedExpr(Arg, Param->getOuterLocStart());
4152     // Build the default argument expression.
4153     return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, Arg);
4154   }
4155 
4156   // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
4157   // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
4158   // be properly destroyed.
4159   // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
4160   // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
4161   // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because
4162   // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything.
4163   if (isa<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) {
4164     // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are
4165     // any explicit objects.
4166     ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
4167 
4168     // Append all the objects to the cleanup list.  Right now, this
4169     // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument
4170     // expressions should never be able to capture anything.
4171     assert(!cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())->getNumObjects() &&
4172            "default argument expression has capturing blocks?");
4173   }
4174 
4175   // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
4176   // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
4177   // as being "referenced".
4178   MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(),
4179                                    /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true);
4180   return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param);
4181 }
4182 
4183 
4184 Sema::VariadicCallType
4185 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4186                           Expr *Fn) {
4187   if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) {
4188     if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl))
4189       return VariadicConstructor;
4190     else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
4191       return VariadicBlock;
4192     else if (FDecl) {
4193       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4194         if (Method->isInstance())
4195           return VariadicMethod;
4196     } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy)
4197       return VariadicMethod;
4198     return VariadicFunction;
4199   }
4200   return VariadicDoesNotApply;
4201 }
4202 
4203 namespace {
4204 class FunctionCallCCC : public FunctionCallFilterCCC {
4205 public:
4206   FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName,
4207                   unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME)
4208       : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME),
4209         FunctionName(FuncName) {}
4210 
4211   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
4212     if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() ||
4213         candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) {
4214       return false;
4215     }
4216 
4217     return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate);
4218   }
4219 
4220 private:
4221   const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName;
4222 };
4223 }
4224 
4225 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn,
4226                                                FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4227                                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
4228   MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn);
4229   DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName();
4230   SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getLocStart();
4231 
4232   if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo(
4233           DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
4234           S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr,
4235           llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(),
4236                                              Args.size(), ME),
4237           Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
4238     if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) {
4239       if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
4240         OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
4241         OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4242         for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(),
4243                                            CDEnd = Corrected.end();
4244              CD != CDEnd; ++CD) {
4245           if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD))
4246             S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args,
4247                                    OCS);
4248         }
4249         switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) {
4250         case OR_Success:
4251           ND = Best->Function;
4252           Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
4253           break;
4254         default:
4255           break;
4256         }
4257       }
4258       if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) {
4259         return Corrected;
4260       }
4261     }
4262   }
4263   return TypoCorrection();
4264 }
4265 
4266 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
4267 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
4268 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
4269 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
4270 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
4271 /// true if the call is ill-formed.
4272 bool
4273 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
4274                               FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4275                               const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4276                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4277                               SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4278                               bool IsExecConfig) {
4279   // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
4280   // We don't need to do this in the
4281   if (FDecl)
4282     if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
4283       if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID))
4284         return false;
4285 
4286   // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
4287   // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
4288   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
4289   bool Invalid = false;
4290   unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams;
4291   unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
4292                        ? 1 /* block */
4293                        : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */
4294                                        : 0 /* function */);
4295 
4296   // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
4297   // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
4298   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
4299     if (Args.size() < MinArgs) {
4300       TypoCorrection TC;
4301       if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
4302         unsigned diag_id =
4303             MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4304                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest
4305                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest;
4306         diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs
4307                                         << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4308                                         << TC.getCorrectionRange());
4309       } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
4310         Diag(RParenLoc,
4311              MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4312                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one
4313                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one)
4314             << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange();
4315       else
4316         Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4317                             ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args
4318                             : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least)
4319             << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4320             << Fn->getSourceRange();
4321 
4322       // Emit the location of the prototype.
4323       if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
4324         Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
4325           << FDecl;
4326 
4327       return true;
4328     }
4329     Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams);
4330   }
4331 
4332   // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
4333   // them.
4334   if (Args.size() > NumParams) {
4335     if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
4336       TypoCorrection TC;
4337       if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
4338         unsigned diag_id =
4339             MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4340                 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest
4341                 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest;
4342         diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams
4343                                         << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4344                                         << TC.getCorrectionRange());
4345       } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl &&
4346                  FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
4347         Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4348              MinArgs == NumParams
4349                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one
4350                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one)
4351             << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0)
4352             << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange()
4353             << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4354                            Args.back()->getLocEnd());
4355       else
4356         Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4357              MinArgs == NumParams
4358                  ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args
4359                  : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most)
4360             << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4361             << Fn->getSourceRange()
4362             << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4363                            Args.back()->getLocEnd());
4364 
4365       // Emit the location of the prototype.
4366       if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
4367         Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
4368           << FDecl;
4369 
4370       // This deletes the extra arguments.
4371       Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams);
4372       return true;
4373     }
4374   }
4375   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
4376   VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn);
4377 
4378   Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getLocStart(), FDecl,
4379                                    Proto, 0, Args, AllArgs, CallType);
4380   if (Invalid)
4381     return true;
4382   unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
4383   for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
4384     Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
4385 
4386   return false;
4387 }
4388 
4389 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4390                                   const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4391                                   unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4392                                   SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs,
4393                                   VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit,
4394                                   bool IsListInitialization) {
4395   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
4396   bool Invalid = false;
4397   unsigned ArgIx = 0;
4398   // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
4399   for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) {
4400     QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i);
4401 
4402     Expr *Arg;
4403     ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr;
4404     if (ArgIx < Args.size()) {
4405       Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
4406 
4407       if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(),
4408                               ProtoArgType,
4409                               diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
4410         return true;
4411 
4412       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
4413       bool CFAudited = false;
4414       if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy &&
4415           FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
4416           (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
4417         Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg);
4418       else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
4419                FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
4420                (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
4421         CFAudited = true;
4422 
4423       InitializedEntity Entity =
4424           Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param,
4425                                                          ProtoArgType)
4426                 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
4427                       Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
4428 
4429       // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API.
4430       if (CFAudited)
4431         Entity.setParameterCFAudited();
4432 
4433       ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(
4434           Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit);
4435       if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4436         return true;
4437 
4438       Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
4439     } else {
4440       assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee");
4441 
4442       ExprResult ArgExpr =
4443         BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
4444       if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
4445         return true;
4446 
4447       Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>();
4448     }
4449 
4450     // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This
4451     // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr
4452     // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator.
4453     CheckArrayAccess(Arg);
4454 
4455     // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7).
4456     CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg);
4457 
4458     AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
4459   }
4460 
4461   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
4462   if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
4463     // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that
4464     // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic.
4465     if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl &&
4466         FDecl->isExternC()) {
4467       for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
4468         QualType paramType; // ignored
4469         ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, Args[i], paramType);
4470         Invalid |= arg.isInvalid();
4471         AllArgs.push_back(arg.get());
4472       }
4473 
4474     // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
4475     } else {
4476       for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
4477         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType,
4478                                                           FDecl);
4479         Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid();
4480         AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get());
4481       }
4482     }
4483 
4484     // Check for array bounds violations.
4485     for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
4486       CheckArrayAccess(Args[i]);
4487   }
4488   return Invalid;
4489 }
4490 
4491 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) {
4492   TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
4493   if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>())
4494     TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc();
4495   if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>())
4496     S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array)
4497       << ATL.getLocalSourceRange();
4498 }
4499 
4500 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static
4501 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by
4502 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large.
4503 ///
4504 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the
4505 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the
4506 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of
4507 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression.
4508 void
4509 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc,
4510                                ParmVarDecl *Param,
4511                                const Expr *ArgExpr) {
4512   // Static array parameters are not supported in C++.
4513   if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4514     return;
4515 
4516   QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType();
4517 
4518   const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy);
4519   if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static)
4520     return;
4521 
4522   if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
4523                                      Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) {
4524     Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange();
4525     DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
4526     return;
4527   }
4528 
4529   const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT);
4530   if (!CAT)
4531     return;
4532 
4533   const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT =
4534     Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType());
4535   if (!ArgCAT)
4536     return;
4537 
4538   if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) {
4539     Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small)
4540       << ArgExpr->getSourceRange()
4541       << (unsigned) ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue()
4542       << (unsigned) CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
4543     DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
4544   }
4545 }
4546 
4547 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
4548 /// to have a function type.
4549 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn);
4550 
4551 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out
4552 /// immediately during argument processing?
4553 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) {
4554   // Placeholders are never sugared.
4555   const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type);
4556   if (!placeholder) return false;
4557 
4558   switch (placeholder->getKind()) {
4559   // Ignore all the non-placeholder types.
4560 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID)
4561 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID:
4562 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
4563     return false;
4564 
4565   // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved
4566   // by the call machinery.
4567   case BuiltinType::Overload:
4568     return false;
4569 
4570   // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and
4571   // should be left in place.
4572   case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast:
4573     return false;
4574 
4575   // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible.
4576   case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
4577     return true;
4578 
4579   // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try
4580   // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types.
4581   case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
4582     return true;
4583 
4584   // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported.
4585   case BuiltinType::BoundMember:
4586   case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn:
4587     return true;
4588   }
4589   llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind");
4590 }
4591 
4592 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to
4593 /// handle later.
4594 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) {
4595   // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of
4596   // dying at the first failure.
4597   bool hasInvalid = false;
4598   for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) {
4599     if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) {
4600       ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]);
4601       if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true;
4602       else args[i] = result.get();
4603     } else if (hasInvalid) {
4604       (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]);
4605     }
4606   }
4607   return hasInvalid;
4608 }
4609 
4610 /// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address
4611 /// space, than it should be able to accept a pointer to any address
4612 /// space as input.  In order to do this, we need to replace the
4613 /// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space
4614 /// as the call.
4615 ///
4616 /// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e.
4617 ///                  it does not contain any pointer arguments without
4618 ///                  an address space qualifer.  Otherwise the rewritten
4619 ///                  FunctionDecl is returned.
4620 /// TODO: Handle pointer return types.
4621 static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context,
4622                                                 const FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4623                                                 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) {
4624 
4625   QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType();
4626   const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType);
4627 
4628   if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) ||
4629       !FT || FT->isVariadic() || ArgExprs.size() != FT->getNumParams())
4630     return nullptr;
4631 
4632   bool NeedsNewDecl = false;
4633   unsigned i = 0;
4634   SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams;
4635 
4636   for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) {
4637 
4638     // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup.
4639     Expr *Arg = Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]).get();
4640     QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
4641     if (!ParamType->isPointerType() ||
4642         ParamType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace() ||
4643         !ArgType->isPointerType() ||
4644         !ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) {
4645       OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType);
4646       continue;
4647     }
4648 
4649     NeedsNewDecl = true;
4650     unsigned AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().getAddressSpace();
4651 
4652     QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType();
4653     PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS);
4654     OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType));
4655   }
4656 
4657   if (!NeedsNewDecl)
4658     return nullptr;
4659 
4660   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
4661   QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(),
4662                                                 OverloadParams, EPI);
4663   DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
4664   FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent,
4665                                                     FDecl->getLocation(),
4666                                                     FDecl->getLocation(),
4667                                                     FDecl->getIdentifier(),
4668                                                     OverloadTy,
4669                                                     /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4670                                                     SC_Extern, false,
4671                                                     /*hasPrototype=*/true);
4672   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
4673   FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy);
4674   for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
4675     QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i);
4676     ParmVarDecl *Parm =
4677         ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(),
4678                                 SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType,
4679                                 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
4680     Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i);
4681     Params.push_back(Parm);
4682   }
4683   OverloadDecl->setParams(Params);
4684   return OverloadDecl;
4685 }
4686 
4687 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
4688 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
4689 /// locations.
4690 ExprResult
4691 Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4692                     MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4693                     Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) {
4694   // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
4695   ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
4696   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4697   Fn = Result.get();
4698 
4699   if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs))
4700     return ExprError();
4701 
4702   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4703     // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
4704     if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
4705       if (!ArgExprs.empty()) {
4706         // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
4707         Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
4708           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
4709                                     SourceRange(ArgExprs[0]->getLocStart(),
4710                                                 ArgExprs.back()->getLocEnd()));
4711       }
4712 
4713       return new (Context)
4714           CallExpr(Context, Fn, None, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4715     }
4716     if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) {
4717       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn);
4718       if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4719       Fn = result.get();
4720     }
4721 
4722     // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
4723     // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
4724     // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
4725     // Fn.
4726     bool Dependent = false;
4727     if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
4728       Dependent = true;
4729     else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs))
4730       Dependent = true;
4731 
4732     if (Dependent) {
4733       if (ExecConfig) {
4734         return new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(
4735             Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs,
4736             Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4737       } else {
4738         return new (Context) CallExpr(
4739             Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4740       }
4741     }
4742 
4743     // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
4744     if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
4745       return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4746                                           RParenLoc);
4747 
4748     if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4749       ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4750       if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4751       Fn = result.get();
4752     }
4753 
4754     if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) {
4755       return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc);
4756     }
4757   }
4758 
4759   // Check for overloaded calls.  This can happen even in C due to extensions.
4760   if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
4761     OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn);
4762 
4763     // We aren't supposed to apply this logic for if there's an '&' involved.
4764     if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) {
4765       OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression;
4766       if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) {
4767         UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl);
4768         return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4769                                        RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
4770       } else {
4771         return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4772                                          RParenLoc);
4773       }
4774     }
4775   }
4776 
4777   // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
4778   if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4779     ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4780     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4781     Fn = result.get();
4782   }
4783 
4784   Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
4785 
4786   NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr;
4787   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
4788     if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
4789       NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
4790 
4791   if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) {
4792     NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
4793 
4794     FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4795     if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) {
4796       // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing paramaters
4797       // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments
4798       // in ArgExprs.
4799       if ((FDecl = rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) {
4800         NDecl = FDecl;
4801         Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(),
4802                            SourceLocation(), FDecl, false,
4803                            SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(),
4804                            Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl);
4805       }
4806     }
4807   } else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn))
4808     NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl();
4809 
4810   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) {
4811     if (FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>()) {
4812       if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(FD, ArgExprs, true)) {
4813         Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
4814              isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) ?
4815                  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call :
4816                  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
4817           << FD << FD->getSourceRange();
4818         Diag(FD->getLocation(),
4819              diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
4820             << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
4821       }
4822     }
4823   }
4824 
4825   return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc,
4826                                ExecConfig, IsExecConfig);
4827 }
4828 
4829 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments.
4830 ///
4831 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type )
4832 ///
4833 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
4834                                  SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
4835                                  SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4836   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
4837   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
4838   QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy);
4839   QualType SrcTy = E->getType();
4840   if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4841     return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc,
4842                           diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size)
4843                      << DstTy
4844                      << SrcTy
4845                      << E->getSourceRange());
4846   return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
4847 }
4848 
4849 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the
4850 /// provided arguments.
4851 ///
4852 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type )
4853 ///
4854 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
4855                                         SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
4856                                         SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4857   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4858   GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo);
4859   return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
4860 }
4861 
4862 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
4863 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy.  The expression should
4864 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
4865 /// block-pointer type.
4866 ///
4867 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
4868 ExprResult
4869 Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
4870                             SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4871                             ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4872                             SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4873                             Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) {
4874   FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4875   unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0);
4876 
4877   // Promote the function operand.
4878   // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting
4879   // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call.
4880   ExprResult Result;
4881   if (BuiltinID &&
4882       Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) {
4883     Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()),
4884                                CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
4885   } else {
4886     Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn);
4887   }
4888   if (Result.isInvalid())
4889     return ExprError();
4890   Fn = Result.get();
4891 
4892   // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks.  This guarantees cleanup
4893   // of arguments and function on error.
4894   CallExpr *TheCall;
4895   if (Config)
4896     TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn,
4897                                                cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args,
4898                                                Context.BoolTy, VK_RValue,
4899                                                RParenLoc);
4900   else
4901     TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, Context.BoolTy,
4902                                      VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4903 
4904   // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
4905   if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID))
4906     return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
4907 
4908  retry:
4909   const FunctionType *FuncT;
4910   if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4911     // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
4912     // have type pointer to function".
4913     FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
4914     if (!FuncT)
4915       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4916                          << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4917   } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT =
4918                Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4919     FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
4920   } else {
4921     // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type.
4922     if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4923       ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4924       if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4925       Fn = rewrite.get();
4926       TheCall->setCallee(Fn);
4927       goto retry;
4928     }
4929 
4930     return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4931       << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4932   }
4933 
4934   if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
4935     if (Config) {
4936       // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions
4937       if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
4938         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function)
4939             << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4940 
4941       // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type
4942       if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType())
4943         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return)
4944             << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4945     } else {
4946       // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured
4947       if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
4948         return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config)
4949             << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4950     }
4951   }
4952 
4953   // Check for a valid return type
4954   if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getLocStart(), TheCall,
4955                           FDecl))
4956     return ExprError();
4957 
4958   // We know the result type of the call, set it.
4959   TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
4960   TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType()));
4961 
4962   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT);
4963   if (Proto) {
4964     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc,
4965                                 IsExecConfig))
4966       return ExprError();
4967   } else {
4968     assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
4969 
4970     if (FDecl) {
4971       // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
4972       // on our knowledge of the function definition.
4973       const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
4974       if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) {
4975         Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4976        if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size()))
4977           Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
4978           << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
4979       }
4980 
4981       // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
4982       // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
4983       if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
4984         Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4985     }
4986 
4987     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
4988     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) {
4989       Expr *Arg = Args[i];
4990 
4991       if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) {
4992         InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
4993             Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
4994         ExprResult ArgE =
4995             PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg);
4996         if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4997           return true;
4998 
4999         Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
5000 
5001       } else {
5002         ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
5003 
5004         if (ArgE.isInvalid())
5005           return true;
5006 
5007         Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
5008       }
5009 
5010       if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(),
5011                               Arg->getType(),
5012                               diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
5013         return ExprError();
5014 
5015       TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
5016     }
5017   }
5018 
5019   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
5020     if (!Method->isStatic())
5021       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
5022         << Fn->getSourceRange());
5023 
5024   // Check for sentinels
5025   if (NDecl)
5026     DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args);
5027 
5028   // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
5029   if (FDecl) {
5030     if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto))
5031       return ExprError();
5032 
5033     if (BuiltinID)
5034       return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
5035   } else if (NDecl) {
5036     if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto))
5037       return ExprError();
5038   } else {
5039     if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto))
5040       return ExprError();
5041   }
5042 
5043   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
5044 }
5045 
5046 ExprResult
5047 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
5048                            SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
5049   assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
5050   // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
5051   //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
5052 
5053   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5054   QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
5055   if (!TInfo)
5056     TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
5057 
5058   return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
5059 }
5060 
5061 ExprResult
5062 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
5063                                SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) {
5064   QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
5065 
5066   if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
5067     if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
5068           diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type,
5069           SourceRange(LParenLoc,
5070                       LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
5071       return ExprError();
5072     if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
5073       return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
5074         << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
5075   } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
5076              RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
5077                diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type,
5078                SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
5079     return ExprError();
5080 
5081   InitializedEntity Entity
5082     = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo);
5083   InitializationKind Kind
5084     = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc,
5085                                            SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
5086                                            /*InitList=*/true);
5087   InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr);
5088   ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr,
5089                                       &literalType);
5090   if (Result.isInvalid())
5091     return ExprError();
5092   LiteralExpr = Result.get();
5093 
5094   bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == nullptr;
5095   if (isFileScope &&
5096       !LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
5097       !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() &&
5098       !literalType->isDependentType()) { // 6.5.2.5p3
5099     if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType))
5100       return ExprError();
5101   }
5102 
5103   // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason.
5104   ExprValueKind VK = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue;
5105 
5106   return MaybeBindToTemporary(
5107            new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
5108                                              VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope));
5109 }
5110 
5111 ExprResult
5112 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
5113                     SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
5114   // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders.  Overloads can be
5115   // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't.
5116   for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) {
5117     if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
5118       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]);
5119 
5120       // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because
5121       // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc.
5122       if (result.isInvalid()) continue;
5123 
5124       InitArgList[I] = result.get();
5125     }
5126   }
5127 
5128   // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
5129   // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
5130 
5131   InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList,
5132                                                RBraceLoc);
5133   E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
5134   return E;
5135 }
5136 
5137 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC.
5138 static void maybeExtendBlockObject(Sema &S, ExprResult &E) {
5139   assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType());
5140   assert(E.get()->isRValue());
5141 
5142   // Only do this in an r-value context.
5143   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return;
5144 
5145   E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(S.Context, E.get()->getType(),
5146                                CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(),
5147                                /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue);
5148   S.ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
5149 }
5150 
5151 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object
5152 /// pointer type.
5153 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) {
5154   QualType type = E.get()->getType();
5155   if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5156     return CK_BitCast;
5157   } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) {
5158     maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, E);
5159     return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5160   } else {
5161     assert(type->isPointerType());
5162     return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5163   }
5164 }
5165 
5166 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
5167 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
5168 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) {
5169   // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
5170   // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
5171   // pointers.  Everything else should be possible.
5172 
5173   QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType();
5174   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
5175     return CK_NoOp;
5176 
5177   switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5178   case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5179     llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5180 
5181   case Type::STK_CPointer:
5182   case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5183   case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5184     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5185     case Type::STK_CPointer: {
5186       unsigned SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
5187       unsigned DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
5188       if (SrcAS != DestAS)
5189         return CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
5190       return CK_BitCast;
5191     }
5192     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5193       return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer
5194                 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
5195     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5196       if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer)
5197         return CK_BitCast;
5198       if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer)
5199         return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5200       maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, Src);
5201       return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5202     case Type::STK_Bool:
5203       return CK_PointerToBoolean;
5204     case Type::STK_Integral:
5205       return CK_PointerToIntegral;
5206     case Type::STK_Floating:
5207     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5208     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5209     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5210       llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
5211     }
5212     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5213 
5214   case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
5215   case Type::STK_Integral:
5216     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5217     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5218     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5219     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5220       if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5221                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
5222         return CK_NullToPointer;
5223       return CK_IntegralToPointer;
5224     case Type::STK_Bool:
5225       return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
5226     case Type::STK_Integral:
5227       return CK_IntegralCast;
5228     case Type::STK_Floating:
5229       return CK_IntegralToFloating;
5230     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5231       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5232                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5233                               CK_IntegralCast);
5234       return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
5235     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5236       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5237                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5238                               CK_IntegralToFloating);
5239       return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
5240     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5241       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5242     }
5243     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5244 
5245   case Type::STK_Floating:
5246     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5247     case Type::STK_Floating:
5248       return CK_FloatingCast;
5249     case Type::STK_Bool:
5250       return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
5251     case Type::STK_Integral:
5252       return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
5253     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5254       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5255                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5256                               CK_FloatingCast);
5257       return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
5258     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5259       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5260                               DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5261                               CK_FloatingToIntegral);
5262       return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
5263     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5264     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5265     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5266       llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
5267     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5268       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5269     }
5270     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5271 
5272   case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5273     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5274     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5275       return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
5276     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5277       return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
5278     case Type::STK_Floating: {
5279       QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
5280       if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
5281         return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
5282       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
5283       return CK_FloatingCast;
5284     }
5285     case Type::STK_Bool:
5286       return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
5287     case Type::STK_Integral:
5288       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5289                               SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5290                               CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
5291       return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
5292     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5293     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5294     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5295       llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
5296     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5297       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5298     }
5299     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5300 
5301   case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5302     switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5303     case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5304       return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
5305     case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5306       return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
5307     case Type::STK_Integral: {
5308       QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
5309       if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
5310         return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
5311       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
5312       return CK_IntegralCast;
5313     }
5314     case Type::STK_Bool:
5315       return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
5316     case Type::STK_Floating:
5317       Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5318                               SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5319                               CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
5320       return CK_IntegralToFloating;
5321     case Type::STK_CPointer:
5322     case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5323     case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5324       llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
5325     case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5326       llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5327     }
5328     llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5329   }
5330 
5331   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
5332 }
5333 
5334 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len,
5335                                 QualType &eltType) {
5336   // Vectors are simple.
5337   if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5338     len = vecType->getNumElements();
5339     eltType = vecType->getElementType();
5340     assert(eltType->isScalarType());
5341     return true;
5342   }
5343 
5344   // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if
5345   // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types).
5346   if (!type->isRealType()) return false;
5347 
5348   len = 1;
5349   eltType = type;
5350   return true;
5351 }
5352 
5353 static bool VectorTypesMatch(Sema &S, QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
5354   uint64_t srcLen, destLen;
5355   QualType srcElt, destElt;
5356   if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcElt)) return false;
5357   if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destElt)) return false;
5358 
5359   // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a
5360   // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw
5361   // element size multiplied by the element count.
5362   uint64_t srcEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(srcElt);
5363   uint64_t destEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(destElt);
5364 
5365   return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize);
5366 }
5367 
5368 /// Is this a legal conversion between two known vector types?
5369 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
5370   assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType());
5371 
5372   if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions)
5373     return false;
5374   return VectorTypesMatch(*this, srcTy, destTy);
5375 }
5376 
5377 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
5378                            CastKind &Kind) {
5379   assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
5380 
5381   if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
5382     if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, Ty, VectorTy))
5383       return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5384                   Ty->isVectorType() ?
5385                   diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
5386                   diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
5387         << VectorTy << Ty << R;
5388   } else
5389     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5390                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
5391       << VectorTy << Ty << R;
5392 
5393   Kind = CK_BitCast;
5394   return false;
5395 }
5396 
5397 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy,
5398                                     Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) {
5399   assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
5400 
5401   QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
5402 
5403   // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
5404   // an ExtVectorType.
5405   // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed.
5406   // (See OpenCL 6.2).
5407   if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
5408     if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, SrcTy, DestTy)
5409         || (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
5410             (DestTy.getCanonicalType() != SrcTy.getCanonicalType()))) {
5411       Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
5412         << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
5413       return ExprError();
5414     }
5415     Kind = CK_BitCast;
5416     return CastExpr;
5417   }
5418 
5419   // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type.  The appropriate
5420   // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
5421   // splat from elt type to vector.
5422   if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
5423     return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5424                 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
5425       << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
5426 
5427   QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
5428   ExprResult CastExprRes = CastExpr;
5429   CastKind CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy);
5430   if (CastExprRes.isInvalid())
5431     return ExprError();
5432   CastExpr = ImpCastExprToType(CastExprRes.get(), DestElemTy, CK).get();
5433 
5434   Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
5435   return CastExpr;
5436 }
5437 
5438 ExprResult
5439 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
5440                     Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty,
5441                     SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) {
5442   assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) &&
5443          "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
5444 
5445   TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType());
5446   if (D.isInvalidType())
5447     return ExprError();
5448 
5449   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5450     // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only).
5451     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
5452   } else {
5453     // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with.
5454     ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr);
5455     if (!Res.isUsable())
5456       return ExprError();
5457     CastExpr = Res.get();
5458   }
5459 
5460   checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D);
5461 
5462   QualType castType = castTInfo->getType();
5463   Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo);
5464 
5465   bool isVectorLiteral = false;
5466 
5467   // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal,
5468   // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
5469   ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr);
5470   ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr);
5471   if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().OpenCL)
5472        && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) {
5473     if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
5474       Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
5475       return ExprError();
5476     }
5477     if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
5478       Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0));
5479       if (!E->getType()->isVectorType())
5480         isVectorLiteral = true;
5481     }
5482     else
5483       isVectorLiteral = true;
5484   }
5485 
5486   // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
5487   // then handle it as such.
5488   if (isVectorLiteral)
5489     return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo);
5490 
5491   // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
5492   // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
5493   // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
5494   if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) {
5495     ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr);
5496     if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
5497     CastExpr = Result.get();
5498   }
5499 
5500   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() &&
5501       !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc))
5502     Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange();
5503 
5504   CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr);
5505 
5506   CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr);
5507 
5508   return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr);
5509 }
5510 
5511 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,
5512                                     SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E,
5513                                     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
5514   assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) &&
5515          "Expected paren or paren list expression");
5516 
5517   Expr **exprs;
5518   unsigned numExprs;
5519   Expr *subExpr;
5520   SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc;
5521   if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) {
5522     LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc();
5523     LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc();
5524     exprs = PE->getExprs();
5525     numExprs = PE->getNumExprs();
5526   } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance
5527     LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen();
5528     LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen();
5529     subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr();
5530     exprs = &subExpr;
5531     numExprs = 1;
5532   }
5533 
5534   QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
5535   assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type");
5536 
5537   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
5538   const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>();
5539   unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements();
5540 
5541   // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of
5542   // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector.
5543   // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be
5544   // replicated to all the components of the vector
5545   if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) {
5546     // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the
5547     // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will
5548     // be replicated to all the components of the vector
5549     if (numExprs == 1) {
5550       QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
5551       ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
5552       if (Literal.isInvalid())
5553         return ExprError();
5554       Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
5555                                   PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
5556       return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
5557     }
5558     else if (numExprs < numElems) {
5559       Diag(E->getExprLoc(),
5560            diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers);
5561       return ExprError();
5562     }
5563     else
5564       initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
5565   }
5566   else {
5567     // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value,
5568     // it will be replicated to all components of the vector.
5569     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
5570         VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector &&
5571         numExprs == 1) {
5572         QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
5573         ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
5574         if (Literal.isInvalid())
5575           return ExprError();
5576         Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
5577                                     PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
5578         return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
5579     }
5580 
5581     initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
5582   }
5583   // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
5584   // braces instead of the original commas.
5585   InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc,
5586                                                    initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc);
5587   initE->setType(Ty);
5588   return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE);
5589 }
5590 
5591 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn
5592 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators.
5593 ExprResult
5594 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) {
5595   ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr);
5596   if (!E)
5597     return OrigExpr;
5598 
5599   ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
5600 
5601   for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
5602     Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
5603                         E->getExpr(i));
5604 
5605   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
5606 
5607   return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
5608 }
5609 
5610 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
5611                                     SourceLocation R,
5612                                     MultiExprArg Val) {
5613   Expr *expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, Val, R);
5614   return expr;
5615 }
5616 
5617 /// \brief Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer
5618 /// constant and the other is not a pointer.  Returns true if a diagnostic is
5619 /// emitted.
5620 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
5621                                       SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5622   Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr;
5623   Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr;
5624   Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind =
5625       NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5626                                       Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
5627 
5628   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) {
5629     NullExpr = RHSExpr;
5630     NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr;
5631     NullKind =
5632         NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5633                                         Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
5634   }
5635 
5636   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull)
5637     return false;
5638 
5639   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression)
5640     return false;
5641 
5642   if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) {
5643     // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL"
5644     // string in the source code.
5645     NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
5646     SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc();
5647     if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL"))
5648       return false;
5649   }
5650 
5651   int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr);
5652   Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null)
5653       << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType
5654       << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
5655   return true;
5656 }
5657 
5658 /// \brief Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise.
5659 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5660   QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
5661 
5662   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type.
5663   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) {
5664     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
5665       << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
5666     return true;
5667   }
5668 
5669   // C99 6.5.15p2
5670   if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false;
5671 
5672   S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
5673     << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
5674   return true;
5675 }
5676 
5677 /// \brief Handle when one or both operands are void type.
5678 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5679                                          ExprResult &RHS) {
5680     Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get();
5681     Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get();
5682 
5683     if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
5684       S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5685         << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
5686     if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
5687       S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5688         << LHSExpr->getSourceRange();
5689     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
5690     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
5691     return S.Context.VoidTy;
5692 }
5693 
5694 /// \brief Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy,
5695 /// true otherwise.
5696 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr,
5697                                         QualType PointerTy) {
5698   if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) ||
5699       !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
5700                                             Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
5701     return true;
5702 
5703   NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer);
5704   return false;
5705 }
5706 
5707 /// \brief Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting
5708 /// type.
5709 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5710                                                      ExprResult &RHS,
5711                                                      SourceLocation Loc) {
5712   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5713   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5714 
5715   if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
5716     // Two identical pointers types are always compatible.
5717     return LHSTy;
5718   }
5719 
5720   QualType lhptee, rhptee;
5721 
5722   // Get the pointee types.
5723   bool IsBlockPointer = false;
5724   if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
5725     lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType();
5726     rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5727     IsBlockPointer = true;
5728   } else {
5729     lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5730     rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5731   }
5732 
5733   // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to
5734   // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
5735   // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite
5736   // type.
5737 
5738   // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified
5739   // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should
5740   // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or
5741   // anything.
5742   Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers();
5743   Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers();
5744 
5745   unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers();
5746   lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
5747   rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
5748 
5749   lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual);
5750   rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual);
5751 
5752   QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee);
5753 
5754   if (CompositeTy.isNull()) {
5755     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
5756       << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
5757       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5758     // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
5759     // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
5760     // to get a consistent AST.
5761     QualType incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
5762     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5763     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5764     return incompatTy;
5765   }
5766 
5767   // The pointer types are compatible.
5768   QualType ResultTy = CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual);
5769   if (IsBlockPointer)
5770     ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy);
5771   else
5772     ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy);
5773 
5774   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast);
5775   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast);
5776   return ResultTy;
5777 }
5778 
5779 /// \brief Returns true if QT is quelified-id and implements 'NSObject' and/or
5780 /// 'NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else); or QT is an NSObject and optionally
5781 /// implements 'NSObject' and/or NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else).
5782 static bool isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, QualType QT) {
5783   if (QT->isObjCIdType())
5784     return true;
5785 
5786   const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5787   if (!OPT)
5788     return false;
5789 
5790   if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5791     if (ID->getIdentifier() != &C.Idents.get("NSObject"))
5792       return false;
5793 
5794   ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSCopying =
5795     S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSCopying"), SourceLocation());
5796   ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSObject =
5797     S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSObject"), SourceLocation());
5798 
5799   for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5800     if ((PNSCopying && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSCopying)) ||
5801         (PNSObject && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSObject)))
5802       ;
5803     else
5804       return false;
5805   }
5806   return true;
5807 }
5808 
5809 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers.
5810 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S,
5811                                                           ExprResult &LHS,
5812                                                           ExprResult &RHS,
5813                                                           SourceLocation Loc) {
5814   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5815   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5816 
5817   if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
5818     if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5819       QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
5820       LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5821       RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5822       return destType;
5823     }
5824     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
5825       << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
5826       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5827     return QualType();
5828   }
5829 
5830   // We have 2 block pointer types.
5831   return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
5832 }
5833 
5834 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers.
5835 static QualType
5836 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5837                                             ExprResult &RHS,
5838                                             SourceLocation Loc) {
5839   // get the pointer types
5840   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5841   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5842 
5843   // get the "pointed to" types
5844   QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5845   QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5846 
5847   // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
5848   if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
5849     // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
5850     QualType destPointee
5851       = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
5852     QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5853     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
5854     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
5855     // Promote to void*.
5856     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5857     return destType;
5858   }
5859   if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
5860     QualType destPointee
5861       = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
5862     QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5863     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
5864     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
5865     // Promote to void*.
5866     LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5867     return destType;
5868   }
5869 
5870   return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
5871 }
5872 
5873 /// \brief Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second
5874 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise.
5875 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int,
5876                                         Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc,
5877                                         bool IsIntFirstExpr) {
5878   if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
5879       !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType())
5880     return false;
5881 
5882   Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr;
5883   Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get();
5884 
5885   S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
5886     << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType()
5887     << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange();
5888   Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(),
5889                             CK_IntegralToPointer);
5890   return true;
5891 }
5892 
5893 /// \brief Simple conversion between integer and floating point types.
5894 ///
5895 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
5896 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
5897 ///
5898 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar
5899 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two
5900 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result
5901 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No
5902 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use
5903 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always
5904 /// promotes promotable types.
5905 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5906                                             ExprResult &RHS,
5907                                             SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5908   LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
5909   if (LHS.isInvalid())
5910     return QualType();
5911   RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
5912   if (RHS.isInvalid())
5913     return QualType();
5914 
5915   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
5916   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
5917   QualType LHSType =
5918     S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5919   QualType RHSType =
5920     S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5921 
5922   if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5923     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
5924       << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5925     return QualType();
5926   }
5927 
5928   if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5929     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
5930       << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5931     return QualType();
5932   }
5933 
5934   // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
5935   if (LHSType == RHSType)
5936     return LHSType;
5937 
5938   // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
5939   if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
5940     return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
5941                                  /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
5942 
5943   // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
5944   return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
5945   (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
5946 }
5947 
5948 /// \brief Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the
5949 ///        condition in length.
5950 ///
5951 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
5952 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
5953 ///
5954 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands
5955 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted
5956 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition
5957 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result
5958 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits.
5959 static QualType
5960 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
5961                               QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5962   QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
5963   if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
5964 
5965   const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
5966   assert(CV);
5967 
5968   // Determine the vector result type
5969   unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements();
5970   QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements);
5971 
5972   // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits
5973   if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType())
5974       != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) {
5975     // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print
5976     // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description.
5977     std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString();
5978     SmallString<64> Str;
5979     llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
5980     OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)";
5981     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
5982       << CondTy << OS.str();
5983     return QualType();
5984   }
5985 
5986   // Convert operands to the vector result type
5987   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
5988   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
5989 
5990   return VectorTy;
5991 }
5992 
5993 /// \brief Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector
5994 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond,
5995                                        SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5996   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of
5997   // integral type.
5998   const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>();
5999   assert(CondTy);
6000   QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType();
6001   if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false;
6002 
6003   S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
6004     << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange();
6005   return true;
6006 }
6007 
6008 /// \brief Return false if the vector condition type and the vector
6009 ///        result type are compatible.
6010 ///
6011 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same
6012 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number
6013 /// of bits.
6014 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy,
6015                               SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6016   const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
6017   const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>();
6018   assert(CV && RV);
6019 
6020   if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) {
6021     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size)
6022       << CondTy << VecResTy;
6023     return true;
6024   }
6025 
6026   QualType CVE = CV->getElementType();
6027   QualType RVE = RV->getElementType();
6028 
6029   if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) {
6030     S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
6031       << CondTy << VecResTy;
6032     return true;
6033   }
6034 
6035   return false;
6036 }
6037 
6038 /// \brief Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in
6039 ///        OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1
6040 ///        s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type.
6041 static QualType
6042 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond,
6043                              ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
6044                              SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6045   Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get());
6046   if (Cond.isInvalid())
6047     return QualType();
6048   QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType();
6049 
6050   if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
6051     return QualType();
6052 
6053   // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the
6054   // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i.
6055   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6056       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6057     QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc,
6058                                               /*isCompAssign*/false);
6059     if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
6060     // The result type must match the condition type as specified in
6061     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6.
6062     if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc))
6063       return QualType();
6064     return VecResTy;
6065   }
6066 
6067   // Both operands are scalar.
6068   return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc);
6069 }
6070 
6071 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
6072 /// In that case, LHS = cond.
6073 /// C99 6.5.15
6074 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS,
6075                                         ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK,
6076                                         ExprObjectKind &OK,
6077                                         SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6078 
6079   ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
6080   if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
6081   LHS = LHSResult;
6082 
6083   ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
6084   if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
6085   RHS = RHSResult;
6086 
6087   // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
6088   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6089     return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
6090 
6091   VK = VK_RValue;
6092   OK = OK_Ordinary;
6093 
6094   // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently
6095   // different to merit its own checker.
6096   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
6097     return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
6098 
6099   // First, check the condition.
6100   Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get());
6101   if (Cond.isInvalid())
6102     return QualType();
6103   if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
6104     return QualType();
6105 
6106   // Now check the two expressions.
6107   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6108       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
6109     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false);
6110 
6111   QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
6112   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
6113     return QualType();
6114 
6115   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
6116   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
6117 
6118   // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
6119   // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
6120   if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
6121     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy));
6122     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy));
6123 
6124     return ResTy;
6125   }
6126 
6127   // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
6128   // type.
6129   if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {    // C99 6.5.15p3
6130     if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
6131       if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
6132         // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
6133         // that type."  This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
6134         return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
6135     // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
6136   }
6137 
6138   // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
6139   // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
6140   if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
6141     return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS);
6142   }
6143 
6144   // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
6145   // the type of the other operand."
6146   if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy;
6147   if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy;
6148 
6149   // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
6150   QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
6151                                                         QuestionLoc);
6152   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
6153     return QualType();
6154   if (!compositeType.isNull())
6155     return compositeType;
6156 
6157 
6158   // Handle block pointer types.
6159   if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType())
6160     return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
6161                                                      QuestionLoc);
6162 
6163   // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
6164   if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType())
6165     return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
6166                                                        QuestionLoc);
6167 
6168   // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.  Note that
6169   // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
6170   if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6171       /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true))
6172     return RHSTy;
6173   if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6174       /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false))
6175     return LHSTy;
6176 
6177   // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer
6178   // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most
6179   // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression.
6180   if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc))
6181     return QualType();
6182 
6183   // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
6184   Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
6185     << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6186     << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6187   return QualType();
6188 }
6189 
6190 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
6191 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
6192 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
6193                                             SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6194   QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
6195   QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
6196 
6197   // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*.  Here we case the result
6198   // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
6199   // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
6200   if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
6201       (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
6202     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6203     return LHSTy;
6204   }
6205   if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
6206       (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
6207     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6208     return RHSTy;
6209   }
6210   // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
6211   if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
6212       (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
6213     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6214     return LHSTy;
6215   }
6216   if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
6217       (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
6218     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6219     return RHSTy;
6220   }
6221   // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
6222   if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
6223       (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
6224     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
6225     return LHSTy;
6226   }
6227   if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
6228       (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
6229     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
6230     return RHSTy;
6231   }
6232   // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
6233   if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6234 
6235     if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
6236       // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
6237       return LHSTy;
6238     }
6239     const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6240     const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6241     QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
6242 
6243     // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
6244     // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
6245     // type. This allows
6246     //   xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
6247     // where B is a subclass of A.
6248     //
6249     // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
6250     // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
6251     // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
6252     // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
6253 
6254     // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
6255     // It could return the composite type.
6256     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
6257       compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
6258     } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
6259       compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
6260     } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
6261                 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
6262                Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
6263       // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
6264       // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
6265       // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
6266       // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
6267       compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
6268     } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
6269       compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
6270     } else if (!(compositeType =
6271                  Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
6272       ;
6273     else {
6274       Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
6275       << LHSTy << RHSTy
6276       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6277       QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
6278       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
6279       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
6280       return incompatTy;
6281     }
6282     // The object pointer types are compatible.
6283     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
6284     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
6285     return compositeType;
6286   }
6287   // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
6288   if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6289     if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
6290       // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
6291       // so these types are not compatible.
6292       Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
6293           << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6294       LHS = RHS = true;
6295       return QualType();
6296     }
6297     QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6298     QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6299     QualType destPointee
6300     = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
6301     QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
6302     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
6303     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
6304     // Promote to void*.
6305     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
6306     return destType;
6307   }
6308   if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
6309     if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
6310       // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
6311       // so these types are not compatible.
6312       Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
6313           << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6314       LHS = RHS = true;
6315       return QualType();
6316     }
6317     QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6318     QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6319     QualType destPointee
6320     = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
6321     QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
6322     // Add qualifiers if necessary.
6323     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
6324     // Promote to void*.
6325     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
6326     return destType;
6327   }
6328   return QualType();
6329 }
6330 
6331 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps
6332 /// ParenRange in parentheses.
6333 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6334                                const PartialDiagnostic &Note,
6335                                SourceRange ParenRange) {
6336   SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
6337   if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() &&
6338       EndLoc.isValid()) {
6339     Self.Diag(Loc, Note)
6340       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6341       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
6342   } else {
6343     // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note.
6344     Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange;
6345   }
6346 }
6347 
6348 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
6349   return Opc >= BO_Mul && Opc <= BO_Shr;
6350 }
6351 
6352 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary
6353 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator,
6354 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side
6355 /// expression.
6356 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode,
6357                                    Expr **RHSExprs) {
6358   // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis.
6359   E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
6360   E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator();
6361   E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
6362 
6363   // Built-in binary operator.
6364   if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
6365     if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) {
6366       *Opcode = OP->getOpcode();
6367       *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS();
6368       return true;
6369     }
6370   }
6371 
6372   // Overloaded operator.
6373   if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
6374     if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2)
6375       return false;
6376 
6377     // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into
6378     // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op.
6379     OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator();
6380     if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow ||
6381         OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus)
6382       return false;
6383 
6384     BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO);
6385     if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) {
6386       *Opcode = OpKind;
6387       *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1);
6388       return true;
6389     }
6390   }
6391 
6392   return false;
6393 }
6394 
6395 static bool IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
6396   return (Opc >= BO_LT && Opc <= BO_NE) || (Opc >= BO_LAnd && Opc <= BO_LOr);
6397 }
6398 
6399 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type
6400 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is
6401 /// commonly interpreted as boolean.
6402 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) {
6403   E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
6404 
6405   if (E->getType()->isBooleanType())
6406     return true;
6407   if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
6408     return IsLogicOp(OP->getOpcode());
6409   if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E))
6410     return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot;
6411   if (E->getType()->isPointerType())
6412     return true;
6413 
6414   return false;
6415 }
6416 
6417 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator
6418 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed
6419 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example:
6420 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2".
6421 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self,
6422                                           SourceLocation OpLoc,
6423                                           Expr *Condition,
6424                                           Expr *LHSExpr,
6425                                           Expr *RHSExpr) {
6426   BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode;
6427   Expr *CondRHS;
6428 
6429   if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS))
6430     return;
6431   if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS))
6432     return;
6433 
6434   // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right-
6435   // hand side that looks boolean, so warn.
6436 
6437   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional)
6438       << Condition->getSourceRange()
6439       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode);
6440 
6441   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
6442     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
6443       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode),
6444     SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd()));
6445 
6446   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
6447     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first),
6448     SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()));
6449 }
6450 
6451 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation.  Note that 'LHS' may be null
6452 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
6453 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
6454                                     SourceLocation ColonLoc,
6455                                     Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
6456                                     Expr *RHSExpr) {
6457   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6458     // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it
6459     // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
6460     // been dealt with before checking the operands.
6461     ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr);
6462     if (!CondResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
6463     CondExpr = CondResult.get();
6464   }
6465 
6466   // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
6467   // was the condition.
6468   OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr;
6469   Expr *commonExpr = nullptr;
6470   if (!LHSExpr) {
6471     commonExpr = CondExpr;
6472     // Lower out placeholder types first.  This is important so that we don't
6473     // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such
6474     // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax.
6475     if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) {
6476       ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr);
6477       if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
6478       commonExpr = result.get();
6479     }
6480     // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except
6481     // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional.
6482     if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
6483           && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent()
6484           && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind()
6485           && commonExpr->isGLValue()
6486           && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
6487           && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
6488           && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) {
6489       ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr);
6490       if (commonRes.isInvalid())
6491         return ExprError();
6492       commonExpr = commonRes.get();
6493     }
6494 
6495     opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(),
6496                                                 commonExpr->getType(),
6497                                                 commonExpr->getValueKind(),
6498                                                 commonExpr->getObjectKind(),
6499                                                 commonExpr);
6500     LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue;
6501   }
6502 
6503   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
6504   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
6505   ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
6506   QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS,
6507                                              VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
6508   if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() ||
6509       RHS.isInvalid())
6510     return ExprError();
6511 
6512   DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(),
6513                                 RHS.get());
6514 
6515   if (!commonExpr)
6516     return new (Context)
6517         ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc,
6518                             RHS.get(), result, VK, OK);
6519 
6520   return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator(
6521       commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6522       ColonLoc, result, VK, OK);
6523 }
6524 
6525 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
6526 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
6527 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
6528 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
6529 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
6530 static Sema::AssignConvertType
6531 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
6532   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
6533   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
6534 
6535   // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
6536   const Type *lhptee, *rhptee;
6537   Qualifiers lhq, rhq;
6538   std::tie(lhptee, lhq) =
6539       cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
6540   std::tie(rhptee, rhq) =
6541       cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
6542 
6543   Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
6544 
6545   // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
6546   // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
6547   // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
6548 
6549   // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay.
6550   if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() &&
6551       lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) {
6552     // Ignore lifetime for further calculation.
6553     lhq.removeObjCLifetime();
6554     rhq.removeObjCLifetime();
6555   }
6556 
6557   if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) {
6558     // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal.  TODO: address subspaces
6559     if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq))
6560       ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6561 
6562     // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to
6563     // and from void*.
6564     else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()
6565                         .compatiblyIncludes(
6566                                 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime())
6567              && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType()))
6568       ; // keep old
6569 
6570     // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal.
6571     else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime())
6572       ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6573 
6574     // For GCC compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated
6575     // as still compatible in C.
6576     else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6577   }
6578 
6579   // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
6580   // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
6581   // version of void...
6582   if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
6583     if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
6584       return ConvTy;
6585 
6586     // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
6587     assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
6588     return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
6589   }
6590 
6591   if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
6592     if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
6593       return ConvTy;
6594 
6595     // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
6596     assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
6597     return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
6598   }
6599 
6600   // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
6601   // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
6602   QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0);
6603   if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) {
6604     // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
6605     // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
6606     // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
6607     if (lhptee->isCharType())
6608       ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
6609     else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
6610       ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans);
6611 
6612     if (rhptee->isCharType())
6613       rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
6614     else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
6615       rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans);
6616 
6617     if (ltrans == rtrans) {
6618       // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
6619       // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
6620       // warning can be disabled.
6621       if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible)
6622         return ConvTy;
6623 
6624       return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign;
6625     }
6626 
6627     // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
6628     // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
6629     // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
6630     // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
6631     if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) {
6632       do {
6633         lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
6634         rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
6635       } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee));
6636 
6637       if (lhptee == rhptee)
6638         return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
6639     }
6640 
6641     // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
6642     return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6643   }
6644   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
6645       S.IsNoReturnConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans))
6646     return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6647   return ConvTy;
6648 }
6649 
6650 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
6651 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
6652 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
6653 // types.
6654 static Sema::AssignConvertType
6655 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
6656                                     QualType RHSType) {
6657   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
6658   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
6659 
6660   QualType lhptee, rhptee;
6661 
6662   // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
6663   lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType();
6664   rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType();
6665 
6666   // In C++, the types have to match exactly.
6667   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6668     return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
6669 
6670   Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
6671 
6672   // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
6673   if (lhptee.getLocalQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalQualifiers())
6674     ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6675 
6676   if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
6677     return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
6678 
6679   return ConvTy;
6680 }
6681 
6682 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
6683 /// for assignment compatibility.
6684 static Sema::AssignConvertType
6685 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
6686                                    QualType RHSType) {
6687   assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!");
6688   assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!");
6689 
6690   if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6691     // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
6692     if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
6693         !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
6694       return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6695     return Sema::Compatible;
6696   }
6697   if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6698     if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
6699         !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
6700       return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6701     return Sema::Compatible;
6702   }
6703   QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6704   QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6705 
6706   if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) &&
6707       // make an exception for id<P>
6708       !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6709     return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6710 
6711   if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
6712     return Sema::Compatible;
6713   if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6714     return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
6715   return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6716 }
6717 
6718 Sema::AssignConvertType
6719 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,
6720                                  QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
6721   // Fake up an opaque expression.  We don't actually care about what
6722   // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
6723   // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
6724   // usually happen on valid code.
6725   OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue);
6726   ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr;
6727   CastKind K = CK_Invalid;
6728 
6729   return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K);
6730 }
6731 
6732 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
6733 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
6734 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
6735 ///
6736 ///  int a, *pint;
6737 ///  short *pshort;
6738 ///  struct foo *pfoo;
6739 ///
6740 ///  pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
6741 ///  a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
6742 ///  pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
6743 ///  pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
6744 ///
6745 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
6746 /// C99 spec dictates.
6747 ///
6748 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
6749 Sema::AssignConvertType
6750 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
6751                                  CastKind &Kind) {
6752   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
6753   QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType;
6754 
6755   // Get canonical types.  We're not formatting these types, just comparing
6756   // them.
6757   LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
6758   RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
6759 
6760   // Common case: no conversion required.
6761   if (LHSType == RHSType) {
6762     Kind = CK_NoOp;
6763     return Compatible;
6764   }
6765 
6766   // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an
6767   // atomic qualification step.
6768   if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) {
6769     Sema::AssignConvertType result =
6770       CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind);
6771     if (result != Compatible)
6772       return result;
6773     if (Kind != CK_NoOp)
6774       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind);
6775     Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic;
6776     return Compatible;
6777   }
6778 
6779   // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
6780   // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
6781   // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
6782   // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
6783   // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
6784   // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
6785   // type.
6786   if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6787     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) {
6788       Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
6789       return Compatible;
6790     }
6791     return Incompatible;
6792   }
6793 
6794   // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
6795   // to the same ExtVector type.
6796   if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) {
6797     if (RHSType->isExtVectorType())
6798       return Incompatible;
6799     if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) {
6800       // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the
6801       // element type.
6802       QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(LHSType)->getElementType();
6803       if (elType != RHSType) {
6804         Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, elType);
6805         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), elType, Kind);
6806       }
6807       Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
6808       return Compatible;
6809     }
6810   }
6811 
6812   // Conversions to or from vector type.
6813   if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) {
6814     if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) {
6815       // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
6816       // vector type and vice versa
6817       if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
6818         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6819         return Compatible;
6820       }
6821 
6822       // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
6823       // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
6824       // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
6825       if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
6826         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6827         return IncompatibleVectors;
6828       }
6829     }
6830     return Incompatible;
6831   }
6832 
6833   // Arithmetic conversions.
6834   if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() &&
6835       !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) {
6836     Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType);
6837     return Compatible;
6838   }
6839 
6840   // Conversions to normal pointers.
6841   if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) {
6842     // U* -> T*
6843     if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6844       unsigned AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6845       unsigned AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6846       Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast;
6847       return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6848     }
6849 
6850     // int -> T*
6851     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6852       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
6853       return IntToPointer;
6854     }
6855 
6856     // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
6857     // with two exceptions:
6858     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
6859       //  - conversions to void*
6860       if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6861         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6862         return Compatible;
6863       }
6864 
6865       //  - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type
6866       if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
6867           Context.hasSameType(LHSType,
6868                               Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
6869         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6870         return Compatible;
6871       }
6872 
6873       Kind = CK_BitCast;
6874       return IncompatiblePointer;
6875     }
6876 
6877     // U^ -> void*
6878     if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
6879       if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6880         Kind = CK_BitCast;
6881         return Compatible;
6882       }
6883     }
6884 
6885     return Incompatible;
6886   }
6887 
6888   // Conversions to block pointers.
6889   if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) {
6890     // U^ -> T^
6891     if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
6892       Kind = CK_BitCast;
6893       return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6894     }
6895 
6896     // int or null -> T^
6897     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6898       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
6899       return IntToBlockPointer;
6900     }
6901 
6902     // id -> T^
6903     if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) {
6904       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
6905       return Compatible;
6906     }
6907 
6908     // void* -> T^
6909     if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())
6910       if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6911         Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
6912         return Compatible;
6913       }
6914 
6915     return Incompatible;
6916   }
6917 
6918   // Conversions to Objective-C pointers.
6919   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) {
6920     // A* -> B*
6921     if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6922       Kind = CK_BitCast;
6923       Sema::AssignConvertType result =
6924         checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6925       if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6926           result == Compatible &&
6927           !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType))
6928         result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
6929       return result;
6930     }
6931 
6932     // int or null -> A*
6933     if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6934       Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
6935       return IntToPointer;
6936     }
6937 
6938     // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
6939     // with two exceptions:
6940     if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6941       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
6942 
6943       //  - conversions from 'void*'
6944       if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) {
6945         return Compatible;
6946       }
6947 
6948       //  - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type
6949       if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
6950           Context.hasSameType(RHSType,
6951                               Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
6952         return Compatible;
6953       }
6954 
6955       return IncompatiblePointer;
6956     }
6957 
6958     // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer.
6959     if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
6960         isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(*this, Context, LHSType)) {
6961       maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, RHS);
6962       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
6963       return Compatible;
6964     }
6965 
6966     return Incompatible;
6967   }
6968 
6969   // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above.
6970   if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6971     // T* -> _Bool
6972     if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
6973       Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
6974       return Compatible;
6975     }
6976 
6977     // T* -> int
6978     if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6979       Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
6980       return PointerToInt;
6981     }
6982 
6983     return Incompatible;
6984   }
6985 
6986   // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above.
6987   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
6988     // T* -> _Bool
6989     if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
6990       Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
6991       return Compatible;
6992     }
6993 
6994     // T* -> int
6995     if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6996       Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
6997       return PointerToInt;
6998     }
6999 
7000     return Incompatible;
7001   }
7002 
7003   // struct A -> struct B
7004   if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) {
7005     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
7006       Kind = CK_NoOp;
7007       return Compatible;
7008     }
7009   }
7010 
7011   return Incompatible;
7012 }
7013 
7014 /// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
7015 /// used to initialize the transparent union.
7016 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C,
7017                                       ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType,
7018                                       FieldDecl *Field) {
7019   // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
7020   // of the transparent union.
7021   Expr *E = EResult.get();
7022   InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
7023                                                    E, SourceLocation());
7024   Initializer->setType(UnionType);
7025   Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
7026 
7027   // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
7028   // union type from this initializer list.
7029   TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
7030   EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
7031                                         VK_RValue, Initializer, false);
7032 }
7033 
7034 Sema::AssignConvertType
7035 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,
7036                                                ExprResult &RHS) {
7037   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
7038 
7039   // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
7040   // transparent_union GCC extension.
7041   const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
7042   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
7043     return Incompatible;
7044 
7045   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
7046   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7047   FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr;
7048   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
7049   for (auto *it : UD->fields()) {
7050     if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7051       // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
7052       // 1) void pointer
7053       // 2) null pointer constant
7054       if (RHSType->isPointerType())
7055         if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
7056           RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
7057           InitField = it;
7058           break;
7059         }
7060 
7061       if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
7062                                            Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
7063         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(),
7064                                 CK_NullToPointer);
7065         InitField = it;
7066         break;
7067       }
7068     }
7069 
7070     CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
7071     if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind)
7072           == Compatible) {
7073       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind);
7074       InitField = it;
7075       break;
7076     }
7077   }
7078 
7079   if (!InitField)
7080     return Incompatible;
7081 
7082   ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField);
7083   return Compatible;
7084 }
7085 
7086 Sema::AssignConvertType
7087 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
7088                                        bool Diagnose,
7089                                        bool DiagnoseCFAudited) {
7090   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7091     if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) {
7092       // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
7093       // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
7094       // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
7095       ExprResult Res;
7096       if (Diagnose) {
7097         Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
7098                                         AA_Assigning);
7099       } else {
7100         ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
7101             TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
7102                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
7103                                   /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
7104                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7105                                   /*CStyle=*/false,
7106                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
7107         if (ICS.isFailure())
7108           return Incompatible;
7109         Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
7110                                         ICS, AA_Assigning);
7111       }
7112       if (Res.isInvalid())
7113         return Incompatible;
7114       Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible;
7115       if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7116           !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType,
7117                                                  RHS.get()->getType()))
7118         result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
7119       RHS = Res;
7120       return result;
7121     }
7122 
7123     // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
7124     // structures.
7125     // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should
7126     // happen there, though.
7127   }
7128 
7129   // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
7130   // a null pointer constant.
7131   if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
7132        LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) &&
7133       RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
7134                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
7135     CastKind Kind;
7136     CXXCastPath Path;
7137     CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, false);
7138     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path);
7139     return Compatible;
7140   }
7141 
7142   // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
7143   // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
7144   // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
7145   // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
7146   //
7147   // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
7148   if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) {
7149     RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
7150     if (RHS.isInvalid())
7151       return Incompatible;
7152   }
7153 
7154   Expr *PRE = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts();
7155   if (ObjCProtocolExpr *OPE = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(PRE)) {
7156     ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = OPE->getProtocol();
7157     if (PDecl && !PDecl->hasDefinition()) {
7158       Diag(PRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_atprotocol_protocol) << PDecl->getName();
7159       Diag(PDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PDecl;
7160     }
7161   }
7162 
7163   CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
7164   Sema::AssignConvertType result =
7165     CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind);
7166 
7167   // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
7168   // type of the assignment expression.
7169   // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
7170   // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
7171   // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
7172   // does not have reference type.
7173   if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) {
7174     QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7175     Expr *E = RHS.get();
7176     if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
7177       CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion,
7178                              DiagnoseCFAudited);
7179     if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 &&
7180         (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getLocStart(),
7181                                           LHSType, E->getType(), E) ||
7182          ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E))) {
7183       RHS = E;
7184       return Compatible;
7185     }
7186 
7187     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind);
7188   }
7189   return result;
7190 }
7191 
7192 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
7193                                ExprResult &RHS) {
7194   Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
7195     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
7196     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7197   return QualType();
7198 }
7199 
7200 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting
7201 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat.
7202 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar
7203 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except
7204 /// for float->int.
7205 ///
7206 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions
7207 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure)
7208 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar,
7209                                      QualType scalarTy,
7210                                      QualType vectorEltTy,
7211                                      QualType vectorTy) {
7212   // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it,
7213   // if necessary.
7214   CastKind scalarCast = CK_Invalid;
7215 
7216   if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
7217     if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
7218       return true;
7219     if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7220         S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0)
7221       return true;
7222     scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast;
7223   } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
7224     if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
7225       if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7226           S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0)
7227         return true;
7228       scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast;
7229     }
7230     else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
7231       scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating;
7232     else
7233       return true;
7234   } else {
7235     return true;
7236   }
7237 
7238   // Adjust scalar if desired.
7239   if (scalar) {
7240     if (scalarCast != CK_Invalid)
7241       *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast);
7242     *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
7243   }
7244   return false;
7245 }
7246 
7247 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7248                                    SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
7249   if (!IsCompAssign) {
7250     LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
7251     if (LHS.isInvalid())
7252       return QualType();
7253   }
7254   RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
7255   if (RHS.isInvalid())
7256     return QualType();
7257 
7258   // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
7259   // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
7260   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7261   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7262 
7263   // If the vector types are identical, return.
7264   if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
7265     return LHSType;
7266 
7267   const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7268   const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7269   assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType);
7270 
7271   // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type.
7272   if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
7273       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
7274     if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
7275       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
7276       return LHSType;
7277     }
7278 
7279     if (!IsCompAssign)
7280       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
7281     return RHSType;
7282   }
7283 
7284   // If there's an ext-vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to
7285   // the vector element type and splat.
7286   if (!RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
7287     if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType,
7288                                   LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType))
7289       return LHSType;
7290   }
7291   if (!LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) {
7292     if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS),
7293                                   LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(),
7294                                   RHSType))
7295       return RHSType;
7296   }
7297 
7298   // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size
7299   // needs to be the same.
7300   // FIXME: Should we really be allowing this?
7301   // FIXME: We really just pick the LHS type arbitrarily?
7302   if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
7303     QualType resultType = LHSType;
7304     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), resultType, CK_BitCast);
7305     return resultType;
7306   }
7307 
7308   // Okay, the expression is invalid.
7309 
7310   // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that.
7311   if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) ||
7312       (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) {
7313     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar)
7314       << LHSType << RHSType
7315       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7316     return QualType();
7317   }
7318 
7319   // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic.
7320   Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
7321     << LHSType << RHSType
7322     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7323   return QualType();
7324 }
7325 
7326 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an
7327 // expression.  These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an
7328 // integer instead of a pointer.
7329 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7330                                 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) {
7331   // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant,
7332   // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively
7333   // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow.
7334   bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
7335   bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
7336 
7337   QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType();
7338 
7339   // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and
7340   // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about.
7341   if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() ||
7342       NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType())
7343     return;
7344 
7345   // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter
7346   // what the other expression is.
7347   if (!IsCompare) {
7348     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation)
7349         << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7350         << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
7351     return;
7352   }
7353 
7354   // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer
7355   // if the other expression is a pointer.
7356   if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() ||
7357       NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType())
7358     return;
7359 
7360   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation)
7361       << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType
7362       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7363 }
7364 
7365 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7366                                            SourceLocation Loc,
7367                                            bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) {
7368   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7369 
7370   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7371       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
7372     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
7373 
7374   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
7375   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7376     return QualType();
7377 
7378 
7379   if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType())
7380     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7381 
7382   // Check for division by zero.
7383   llvm::APSInt RHSValue;
7384   if (IsDiv && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
7385       RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0)
7386     DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7387                         PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
7388                           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7389 
7390   return compType;
7391 }
7392 
7393 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
7394   ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
7395   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7396 
7397   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7398       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7399     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
7400         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7401       return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
7402     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7403   }
7404 
7405   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
7406   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7407     return QualType();
7408 
7409   if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType())
7410     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7411 
7412   // Check for remainder by zero.
7413   llvm::APSInt RHSValue;
7414   if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
7415       RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0)
7416     DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7417                         PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
7418                           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7419 
7420   return compType;
7421 }
7422 
7423 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers.
7424 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7425                                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7426   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7427                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
7428                 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
7429     << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
7430                             << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7431 }
7432 
7433 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer.
7434 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7435                                             Expr *Pointer) {
7436   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7437                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
7438                 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
7439     << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange();
7440 }
7441 
7442 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers.
7443 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7444                                                     Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
7445   assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7446   assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7447   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7448                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
7449                 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
7450     << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
7451     // We only show the second type if it differs from the first.
7452     << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(),
7453                                                    RHS->getType())
7454     << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
7455     << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
7456 }
7457 
7458 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer.
7459 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7460                                                 Expr *Pointer) {
7461   assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7462   S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7463                 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
7464                 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
7465     << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType()
7466     << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */
7467     << Pointer->getSourceRange();
7468 }
7469 
7470 /// \brief Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type
7471 ///
7472 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type
7473 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7474                                                  Expr *Operand) {
7475   QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
7476   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
7477     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
7478 
7479   assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType());
7480   QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
7481   return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
7482                                diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type,
7483                                PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange());
7484 }
7485 
7486 /// \brief Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand.
7487 ///
7488 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types
7489 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed
7490 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an
7491 /// extension.
7492 ///
7493 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
7494 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7495                                             Expr *Operand) {
7496   QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
7497   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
7498     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
7499 
7500   if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true;
7501 
7502   QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
7503   if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
7504     diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
7505     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7506   }
7507   if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
7508     diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
7509     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7510   }
7511 
7512   if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false;
7513 
7514   return true;
7515 }
7516 
7517 /// \brief Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer
7518 /// operands.
7519 ///
7520 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much
7521 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic
7522 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS
7523 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers.
7524 ///
7525 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
7526 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7527                                                 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7528   bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
7529   bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
7530   if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true;
7531 
7532   QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy;
7533   if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
7534   if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
7535 
7536   // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces
7537   if (isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) {
7538     const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
7539     const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
7540     if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) {
7541       S.Diag(Loc,
7542              diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
7543           << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/
7544           << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7545       return false;
7546     }
7547   }
7548 
7549   // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
7550   bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
7551   bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
7552   if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) {
7553     if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
7554     else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr);
7555     else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
7556 
7557     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7558   }
7559 
7560   bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
7561   bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
7562   if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) {
7563     if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
7564     else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc,
7565                                                                 RHSExpr);
7566     else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
7567 
7568     return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7569   }
7570 
7571   if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr))
7572     return false;
7573   if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr))
7574     return false;
7575 
7576   return true;
7577 }
7578 
7579 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string
7580 /// literal.
7581 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7582                                   Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7583   StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7584   Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr;
7585   if (!StrExpr) {
7586     StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7587     IndexExpr = LHSExpr;
7588   }
7589 
7590   bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr &&
7591       IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
7592   if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent())
7593     return;
7594 
7595   llvm::APSInt index;
7596   if (IndexExpr->EvaluateAsInt(index, Self.getASTContext())) {
7597     unsigned StrLenWithNull = StrExpr->getLength() + 1;
7598     if (index.isNonNegative() &&
7599         index <= llvm::APSInt(llvm::APInt(index.getBitWidth(), StrLenWithNull),
7600                               index.isUnsigned()))
7601       return;
7602   }
7603 
7604   SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7605   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int)
7606       << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
7607 
7608   // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str".
7609   if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) {
7610     SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7611     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
7612         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&")
7613         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
7614         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
7615   } else
7616     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
7617 }
7618 
7619 /// \brief Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string.
7620 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7621                                    Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7622   const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr;
7623   const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr =
7624       dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7625 
7626   if (!CharExpr) {
7627     CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7628     StringRefExpr = RHSExpr;
7629   }
7630 
7631   if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr)
7632     return;
7633 
7634   const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType();
7635 
7636   // Return if not a PointerType.
7637   if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType())
7638     return;
7639 
7640   // Return if not a CharacterType.
7641   if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType())
7642     return;
7643 
7644   ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext();
7645   SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7646 
7647   const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType();
7648   if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() &&
7649       CharType->isIntegerType() &&
7650       llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) {
7651     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
7652         << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy;
7653   } else {
7654     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
7655         << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType();
7656   }
7657 
7658   // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str.
7659   if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) {
7660     SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7661     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
7662         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&")
7663         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
7664         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
7665   } else {
7666     Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
7667   }
7668 }
7669 
7670 /// \brief Emit error when two pointers are incompatible.
7671 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7672                                            Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7673   assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7674   assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7675   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
7676     << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
7677     << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7678 }
7679 
7680 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
7681     ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7682     QualType* CompLHSTy) {
7683   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7684 
7685   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7686       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7687     QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
7688     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7689     return compType;
7690   }
7691 
7692   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
7693   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7694     return QualType();
7695 
7696   // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal".
7697   if (Opc == BO_Add) {
7698     diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7699     diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7700   }
7701 
7702   // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
7703   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
7704     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7705     return compType;
7706   }
7707 
7708   // Type-checking.  Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp;
7709   // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer.
7710   Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get();
7711 
7712   bool isObjCPointer;
7713   if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7714     isObjCPointer = false;
7715   } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7716     isObjCPointer = true;
7717   } else {
7718     std::swap(PExp, IExp);
7719     if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7720       isObjCPointer = false;
7721     } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7722       isObjCPointer = true;
7723     } else {
7724       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7725     }
7726   }
7727   assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7728 
7729   if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType())
7730     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7731 
7732   if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp))
7733     return QualType();
7734 
7735   if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp))
7736     return QualType();
7737 
7738   // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
7739   CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp);
7740 
7741   if (CompLHSTy) {
7742     QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
7743     if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
7744       LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7745       if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
7746         LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
7747     }
7748     *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
7749   }
7750 
7751   return PExp->getType();
7752 }
7753 
7754 // C99 6.5.6
7755 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7756                                         SourceLocation Loc,
7757                                         QualType* CompLHSTy) {
7758   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7759 
7760   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7761       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7762     QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy);
7763     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7764     return compType;
7765   }
7766 
7767   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
7768   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7769     return QualType();
7770 
7771   // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
7772 
7773   // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
7774   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
7775     if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7776     return compType;
7777   }
7778 
7779   // Either ptr - int   or   ptr - ptr.
7780   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
7781     QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType();
7782 
7783     // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
7784     if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
7785         checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
7786       return QualType();
7787 
7788     // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
7789     if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
7790       if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
7791         return QualType();
7792 
7793       // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
7794       CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr,
7795                        /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true);
7796 
7797       if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7798       return LHS.get()->getType();
7799     }
7800 
7801     // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
7802     if (const PointerType *RHSPTy
7803           = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7804       QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
7805 
7806       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7807         // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
7808         if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
7809           diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7810         }
7811       } else {
7812         // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
7813         if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
7814                 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
7815                 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
7816           diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7817           return QualType();
7818         }
7819       }
7820 
7821       if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc,
7822                                                LHS.get(), RHS.get()))
7823         return QualType();
7824 
7825       // The pointee type may have zero size.  As an extension, a structure or
7826       // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length.  In this
7827       // case subtraction does not make sense.
7828       if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
7829         CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee);
7830         if (ElementSize.isZero()) {
7831           Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types)
7832             << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType()
7833             << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7834         }
7835       }
7836 
7837       if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7838       return Context.getPointerDiffType();
7839     }
7840   }
7841 
7842   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7843 }
7844 
7845 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
7846   if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7847     return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
7848   return false;
7849 }
7850 
7851 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7852                                    SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7853                                    QualType LHSType) {
7854   // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined),
7855   // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema.
7856   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL)
7857     return;
7858 
7859   llvm::APSInt Right;
7860   // Check right/shifter operand
7861   if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
7862       !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Right, S.Context))
7863     return;
7864 
7865   if (Right.isNegative()) {
7866     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7867                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative)
7868                             << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7869     return;
7870   }
7871   llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
7872                        S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType()));
7873   if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) {
7874     S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7875                           S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth)
7876                             << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7877     return;
7878   }
7879   if (Opc != BO_Shl)
7880     return;
7881 
7882   // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which
7883   // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned
7884   // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value
7885   // representable in the result type, so never warn for those.
7886   llvm::APSInt Left;
7887   if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
7888       !LHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Left, S.Context) ||
7889       LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation())
7890     return;
7891   llvm::APInt ResultBits =
7892       static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits();
7893   if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits))
7894     return;
7895   llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue());
7896   Result = Result.shl(Right);
7897 
7898   // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned
7899   // hexadecimal number.
7900   SmallString<40> HexResult;
7901   Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true);
7902 
7903   // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual
7904   // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the
7905   // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be
7906   // turned off separately if needed.
7907   if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) {
7908     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit)
7909         << HexResult << LHSType
7910         << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7911     return;
7912   }
7913 
7914   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth)
7915     << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType
7916     << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
7917     << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7918 }
7919 
7920 /// \brief Return the resulting type when an OpenCL vector is shifted
7921 ///        by a scalar or vector shift amount.
7922 static QualType checkOpenCLVectorShift(Sema &S,
7923                                        ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7924                                        SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
7925   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector.
7926   if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7927     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector)
7928       << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType()
7929       << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7930     return QualType();
7931   }
7932 
7933   if (!IsCompAssign) {
7934     LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
7935     if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
7936   }
7937 
7938   RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
7939   if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
7940 
7941   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
7942   const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7943   QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy->getElementType();
7944 
7945   // Note that RHS might not be a vector.
7946   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
7947   const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7948   QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType;
7949 
7950   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that the operands need to be integers.
7951   if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
7952     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
7953       << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7954     return QualType();
7955   }
7956 
7957   if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
7958     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
7959       << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7960     return QualType();
7961   }
7962 
7963   if (RHSVecTy) {
7964     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators
7965     // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure
7966     // that the number of elements is the same as LHS...
7967     if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) {
7968       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal)
7969         << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
7970         << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7971       return QualType();
7972     }
7973   } else {
7974     // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS.
7975     QualType VecTy =
7976       S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements());
7977     RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat);
7978   }
7979 
7980   return LHSType;
7981 }
7982 
7983 // C99 6.5.7
7984 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7985                                   SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7986                                   bool IsCompAssign) {
7987   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7988 
7989   // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
7990   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7991       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7992     if (LangOpts.OpenCL)
7993       return checkOpenCLVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
7994     return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
7995   }
7996 
7997   // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
7998   // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
7999 
8000   // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away
8001   // if this is a compound assignment.
8002   ExprResult OldLHS = LHS;
8003   LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
8004   if (LHS.isInvalid())
8005     return QualType();
8006   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8007   if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS;
8008 
8009   // The RHS is simpler.
8010   RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
8011   if (RHS.isInvalid())
8012     return QualType();
8013   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8014 
8015   // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
8016   if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
8017       !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
8018     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8019 
8020   // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
8021   // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
8022   if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) ||
8023       isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) {
8024     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8025   }
8026   // Sanity-check shift operands
8027   DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType);
8028 
8029   // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
8030   return LHSType;
8031 }
8032 
8033 static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
8034   if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
8035     if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
8036       return true;
8037     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
8038       return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
8039   }
8040   return false;
8041 }
8042 
8043 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning.
8044 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS,
8045                                 Expr *RHS) {
8046   QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
8047   QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
8048 
8049   const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
8050   if (!LHSEnumType)
8051     return;
8052   const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
8053   if (!RHSEnumType)
8054     return;
8055 
8056   // Ignore anonymous enums.
8057   if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
8058     return;
8059   if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
8060     return;
8061 
8062   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType))
8063     return;
8064 
8065   S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types)
8066       << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType
8067       << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
8068 }
8069 
8070 /// \brief Diagnose bad pointer comparisons.
8071 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8072                                               ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8073                                               bool IsError) {
8074   S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers
8075                       : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
8076     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
8077     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8078 }
8079 
8080 /// \brief Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type,
8081 /// true otherwise.
8082 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8083                                            ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) {
8084   // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
8085   //   [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
8086   //   conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
8087   //   a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
8088   //   them to their composite pointer type. [...]
8089   //
8090   // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
8091   // comparisons of pointers.
8092 
8093   // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
8094   //   In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
8095   //   member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
8096   //   (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
8097   //   them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
8098   //   the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
8099   //   common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
8100   //   of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
8101   //   that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
8102   //   types.
8103 
8104   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8105   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8106   assert((LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) ||
8107          (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()));
8108 
8109   bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
8110   bool *BoolPtr = S.isSFINAEContext() ? nullptr : &NonStandardCompositeType;
8111   QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS, BoolPtr);
8112   if (T.isNull()) {
8113     diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true);
8114     return true;
8115   }
8116 
8117   if (NonStandardCompositeType)
8118     S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
8119       << LHSType << RHSType << T << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8120       << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8121 
8122   LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast);
8123   RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast);
8124   return false;
8125 }
8126 
8127 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8128                                                     ExprResult &LHS,
8129                                                     ExprResult &RHS,
8130                                                     bool IsError) {
8131   S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
8132                       : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
8133     << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
8134     << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8135 }
8136 
8137 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) {
8138   switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) {
8139   case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
8140   case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
8141   case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
8142   case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass:
8143     return true;
8144   default:
8145     // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal!
8146     return false;
8147   }
8148 }
8149 
8150 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) {
8151   const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type =
8152     LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8153 
8154   // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out.
8155   if (!Type)
8156     return false;
8157 
8158   // Get the LHS object's interface type.
8159   QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType();
8160   if (const ObjCObjectType *iQFaceTy =
8161       InterfaceType->getAsObjCQualifiedInterfaceType())
8162     InterfaceType = iQFaceTy->getBaseType();
8163 
8164   // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out.
8165   if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
8166     return false;
8167 
8168   // Try to find the -isEqual: method.
8169   Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector();
8170   ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel,
8171                                                       InterfaceType,
8172                                                       /*instance=*/true);
8173   if (!Method) {
8174     if (Type->isObjCIdType()) {
8175       // For 'id', just check the global pool.
8176       Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(),
8177                                                   /*receiverId=*/true);
8178     } else {
8179       // Check protocols.
8180       Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type,
8181                                              /*instance=*/true);
8182     }
8183   }
8184 
8185   if (!Method)
8186     return false;
8187 
8188   QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType();
8189   if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType())
8190     return false;
8191 
8192   QualType R = Method->getReturnType();
8193   if (!R->isScalarType())
8194     return false;
8195 
8196   return true;
8197 }
8198 
8199 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) {
8200   FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8201   switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) {
8202     default:
8203       break;
8204     case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
8205       // "string literal"
8206       return LK_String;
8207     case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
8208       // "array literal"
8209       return LK_Array;
8210     case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
8211       // "dictionary literal"
8212       return LK_Dictionary;
8213     case Stmt::BlockExprClass:
8214       return LK_Block;
8215     case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: {
8216       Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
8217       switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) {
8218         case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass:
8219         case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass:
8220         case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass:
8221         case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass:
8222         case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass:
8223           // "numeric literal"
8224           return LK_Numeric;
8225         case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: {
8226           CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind();
8227           // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts.
8228           if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast)
8229             return LK_Numeric;
8230           break;
8231         }
8232         default:
8233           break;
8234       }
8235       return LK_Boxed;
8236     }
8237   }
8238   return LK_None;
8239 }
8240 
8241 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8242                                           ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8243                                           BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){
8244   Expr *Literal;
8245   Expr *Other;
8246   if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) {
8247     Literal = LHS.get();
8248     Other = RHS.get();
8249   } else {
8250     Literal = RHS.get();
8251     Other = LHS.get();
8252   }
8253 
8254   // Don't warn on comparisons against nil.
8255   Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts();
8256   if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(),
8257                                    Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
8258     return;
8259 
8260   // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison.
8261   // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own
8262   // warning flag.
8263   Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal);
8264   assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block);
8265   if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) {
8266     llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind");
8267   }
8268 
8269   if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String)
8270     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison)
8271       << Literal->getSourceRange();
8272   else
8273     S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison)
8274       << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange();
8275 
8276   if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) &&
8277       hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) {
8278     SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getLocStart();
8279     SourceLocation End = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd());
8280     CharSourceRange OpRange =
8281       CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc));
8282 
8283     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal)
8284       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![")
8285       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:")
8286       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]");
8287   }
8288 }
8289 
8290 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
8291                                                 ExprResult &RHS,
8292                                                 SourceLocation Loc,
8293                                                 unsigned OpaqueOpc) {
8294   // This checking requires bools.
8295   if (!S.getLangOpts().Bool) return;
8296 
8297   // Check that left hand side is !something.
8298   UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts());
8299   if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return;
8300 
8301   // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type.
8302   if (RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType()) return;
8303 
8304   // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool.
8305   Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts();
8306   if (SubExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) return;
8307 
8308   // Emit warning.
8309   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_comparison)
8310       << Loc;
8311 
8312   // First note suggest !(x < y)
8313   SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getLocStart();
8314   SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getLocEnd();
8315   FirstClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose);
8316   if (FirstClose.isInvalid())
8317     FirstOpen = SourceLocation();
8318   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix)
8319       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(")
8320       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")");
8321 
8322   // Second note suggests (!x) < y
8323   SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getLocStart();
8324   SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getLocEnd();
8325   SecondClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose);
8326   if (SecondClose.isInvalid())
8327     SecondOpen = SourceLocation();
8328   S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens)
8329       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(")
8330       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")");
8331 }
8332 
8333 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable,
8334 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference.
8335 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) {
8336   if (DeclRefExpr* DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
8337     return DR->getDecl();
8338   if (ObjCIvarRefExpr* Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) {
8339     if (Ivar->isFreeIvar())
8340       return Ivar->getDecl();
8341   }
8342   if (MemberExpr* Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
8343     if (Mem->isImplicitAccess())
8344       return Mem->getMemberDecl();
8345   }
8346   return nullptr;
8347 }
8348 
8349 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
8350 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8351                                     SourceLocation Loc, unsigned OpaqueOpc,
8352                                     bool IsRelational) {
8353   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true);
8354 
8355   BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
8356 
8357   // Handle vector comparisons separately.
8358   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8359       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
8360     return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsRelational);
8361 
8362   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8363   QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8364 
8365   Expr *LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8366   Expr *RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8367 
8368   checkEnumComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8369   diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, OpaqueOpc);
8370 
8371   if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
8372       !(LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && IsRelational) &&
8373       !LHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
8374       !RHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
8375       ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8376     // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
8377     // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
8378     // often indicate logic errors in the program.
8379     //
8380     // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
8381     // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
8382     // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
8383     // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
8384     // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
8385     // result.
8386     ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped);
8387     ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped);
8388     if (DL && DR && DL == DR && !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DL)) {
8389       DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8390                           << 0 // self-
8391                           << (Opc == BO_EQ
8392                               || Opc == BO_LE
8393                               || Opc == BO_GE));
8394     } else if (DL && DR && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType() &&
8395                !DL->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
8396                !DR->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
8397         // what is it always going to eval to?
8398         char always_evals_to;
8399         switch(Opc) {
8400         case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
8401           always_evals_to = 0; // false
8402           break;
8403         case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
8404           always_evals_to = 1; // true
8405           break;
8406         default:
8407           // best we can say is 'a constant'
8408           always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
8409           break;
8410         }
8411         DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8412                             << 1 // array
8413                             << always_evals_to);
8414     }
8415 
8416     if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
8417       LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
8418     if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
8419       RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
8420 
8421     // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
8422     // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
8423     Expr *literalString = nullptr;
8424     Expr *literalStringStripped = nullptr;
8425     if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
8426         !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8427                                             Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
8428       literalString = LHS.get();
8429       literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
8430     } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
8431                 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
8432                !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8433                                             Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
8434       literalString = RHS.get();
8435       literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
8436     }
8437 
8438     if (literalString) {
8439       DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
8440         PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
8441           << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
8442           << literalString->getSourceRange());
8443     }
8444   }
8445 
8446   // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
8447   UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
8448   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
8449     return QualType();
8450 
8451   LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8452   RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8453 
8454   // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
8455   QualType ResultTy = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
8456 
8457   if (IsRelational) {
8458     if (LHSType->isRealType() && RHSType->isRealType())
8459       return ResultTy;
8460   } else {
8461     // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
8462     if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
8463       CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8464 
8465     if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType())
8466       return ResultTy;
8467   }
8468 
8469   const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind =
8470       LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
8471   const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind =
8472       RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
8473   bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
8474   bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
8475 
8476   if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) {
8477     bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ;
8478     if (RHSIsNull)
8479       DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality,
8480                                    RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
8481     else
8482       DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality,
8483                                    LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
8484   }
8485 
8486   // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
8487   // when handling null pointer constants.
8488   if (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
8489     QualType LCanPointeeTy =
8490       LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
8491     QualType RCanPointeeTy =
8492       RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
8493 
8494     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8495       if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
8496         return ResultTy;
8497       if (!IsRelational &&
8498           (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
8499         // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
8500         // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
8501         // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
8502         // conformance with the C++ standard.
8503         if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8504             && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8505           diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(
8506               *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext());
8507 
8508           if (isSFINAEContext())
8509             return QualType();
8510 
8511           RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8512           return ResultTy;
8513         }
8514       }
8515 
8516       if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
8517         return QualType();
8518       else
8519         return ResultTy;
8520     }
8521     // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
8522     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
8523                                    RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
8524       // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
8525       if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
8526         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
8527           << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8528           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8529       }
8530     } else if (!IsRelational &&
8531                (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
8532       // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
8533       if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8534           && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8535         diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8536                                                 /*isError*/false);
8537     } else {
8538       // Invalid
8539       diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false);
8540     }
8541     if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) {
8542       const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8543       if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) {
8544         Diag(Loc,
8545              diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
8546             << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */
8547             << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8548       }
8549       unsigned AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
8550       unsigned AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
8551       CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion
8552                                                : CK_BitCast;
8553       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8554         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind);
8555       else
8556         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind);
8557     }
8558     return ResultTy;
8559   }
8560 
8561   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8562     // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
8563     if (LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isNullPtrType())
8564       return ResultTy;
8565 
8566     // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
8567     // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
8568     if (RHSIsNull &&
8569         ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
8570          (!IsRelational &&
8571           (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
8572       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8573                         LHSType->isMemberPointerType()
8574                           ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
8575                           : CK_NullToPointer);
8576       return ResultTy;
8577     }
8578     if (LHSIsNull &&
8579         ((RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
8580          (!IsRelational &&
8581           (RHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
8582       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8583                         RHSType->isMemberPointerType()
8584                           ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
8585                           : CK_NullToPointer);
8586       return ResultTy;
8587     }
8588 
8589     // Comparison of member pointers.
8590     if (!IsRelational &&
8591         LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()) {
8592       if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
8593         return QualType();
8594       else
8595         return ResultTy;
8596     }
8597 
8598     // Handle scoped enumeration types specifically, since they don't promote
8599     // to integers.
8600     if (LHS.get()->getType()->isEnumeralType() &&
8601         Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS.get()->getType(),
8602                                        RHS.get()->getType()))
8603       return ResultTy;
8604   }
8605 
8606   // Handle block pointer types.
8607   if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
8608       RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
8609     QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8610     QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8611 
8612     if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
8613         !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
8614       Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
8615         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8616         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8617     }
8618     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8619     return ResultTy;
8620   }
8621 
8622   // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
8623   if (!IsRelational
8624       && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType())
8625           || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
8626     if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8627       if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
8628              ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
8629             || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
8630                 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
8631         Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
8632           << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8633           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8634     }
8635     if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8636       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8637                               RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
8638                                 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
8639     else
8640       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8641                               LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
8642                                 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
8643     return ResultTy;
8644   }
8645 
8646   if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
8647       RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8648     const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8649     const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8650     if (LPT || RPT) {
8651       bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
8652       bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
8653 
8654       if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
8655           !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
8656         diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8657                                           /*isError*/false);
8658       }
8659       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8660         Expr *E = LHS.get();
8661         if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
8662           CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion);
8663         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType,
8664                                 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
8665       }
8666       else {
8667         Expr *E = RHS.get();
8668         if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
8669           CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, false,
8670                                  Opc);
8671         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType,
8672                                 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
8673       }
8674       return ResultTy;
8675     }
8676     if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
8677         RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8678       if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType))
8679         diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8680                                           /*isError*/false);
8681       if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS))
8682         diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc);
8683 
8684       if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8685         LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
8686       else
8687         RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8688       return ResultTy;
8689     }
8690   }
8691   if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
8692       (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) {
8693     unsigned DiagID = 0;
8694     bool isError = false;
8695     if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) {
8696       // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers,
8697       // since users tend to want to compare addresses.
8698     } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
8699         (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) {
8700       if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8701         DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
8702     } else if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8703       DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8704     else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8705       DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8706       isError = true;
8707     } else
8708       DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8709 
8710     if (DiagID) {
8711       Diag(Loc, DiagID)
8712         << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8713         << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8714       if (isError)
8715         return QualType();
8716     }
8717 
8718     if (LHSType->isIntegerType())
8719       LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8720                         LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
8721     else
8722       RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8723                         RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
8724     return ResultTy;
8725   }
8726 
8727   // Handle block pointers.
8728   if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull
8729       && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
8730     RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
8731     return ResultTy;
8732   }
8733   if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull
8734       && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
8735     LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
8736     return ResultTy;
8737   }
8738 
8739   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8740 }
8741 
8742 
8743 // Return a signed type that is of identical size and number of elements.
8744 // For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical size
8745 // and number of elements.
8746 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) {
8747   const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>();
8748   unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
8749   if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy))
8750     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8751   else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy))
8752     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8753   else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
8754     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8755   else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
8756     return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8757   assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
8758          "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
8759   return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8760 }
8761 
8762 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
8763 /// operates on extended vector types.  Instead of producing an IntTy result,
8764 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
8765 /// types.
8766 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8767                                           SourceLocation Loc,
8768                                           bool IsRelational) {
8769   // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
8770   // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
8771   QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false);
8772   if (vType.isNull())
8773     return vType;
8774 
8775   QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8776 
8777   // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
8778   // bool for C++, int for C
8779   if (vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector)
8780     return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
8781 
8782   // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
8783   // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc.  These always evaluate to a constant, and
8784   // often indicate logic errors in the program.
8785   if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
8786       ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8787     if (DeclRefExpr* DRL
8788           = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
8789       if (DeclRefExpr* DRR
8790             = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
8791         if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
8792           DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
8793                               PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8794                                 << 0 // self-
8795                                 << 2 // "a constant"
8796                               );
8797   }
8798 
8799   // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
8800   if (!IsRelational && LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
8801     assert (RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation());
8802     CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8803   }
8804 
8805   // Return a signed type for the vector.
8806   return GetSignedVectorType(LHSType);
8807 }
8808 
8809 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8810                                           SourceLocation Loc) {
8811   // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or
8812   // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type.
8813   QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false);
8814   if (vType.isNull())
8815     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8816   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 &&
8817       vType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
8818     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8819 
8820   return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType());
8821 }
8822 
8823 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
8824   ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
8825   checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
8826 
8827   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8828       RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
8829     if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
8830         RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
8831       return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
8832 
8833     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8834   }
8835 
8836   ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS;
8837   QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult,
8838                                                  IsCompAssign);
8839   if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid())
8840     return QualType();
8841   LHS = LHSResult.get();
8842   RHS = RHSResult.get();
8843 
8844   if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
8845     return compType;
8846   return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8847 }
8848 
8849 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
8850   ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
8851 
8852   // Check vector operands differently.
8853   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
8854     return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc);
8855 
8856   // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
8857   // bitwise one.  We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
8858   // is a constant.
8859   if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
8860       !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
8861       RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
8862       // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations.
8863       !Loc.isMacroID() && ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8864     // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
8865     // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
8866     // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
8867     // Parens on the RHS are ignored.
8868     llvm::APSInt Result;
8869     if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context))
8870       if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
8871            !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) ||
8872           (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) {
8873         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
8874           << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8875           << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||");
8876         // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version
8877         Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator)
8878             << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|")
8879             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(
8880                 Loc, Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(Loc, 0, getSourceManager(),
8881                                                 getLangOpts())),
8882                                             Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
8883         if (Opc == BO_LAnd)
8884           // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()"
8885           Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant)
8886               << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
8887                   SourceRange(
8888                       Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd(),
8889                                                  0, getSourceManager(),
8890                                                  getLangOpts()),
8891                       RHS.get()->getLocEnd()));
8892       }
8893   }
8894 
8895   if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8896     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do
8897     // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types.
8898     if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
8899         Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
8900       if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() ||
8901           RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType())
8902         return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8903     }
8904 
8905     LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
8906     if (LHS.isInvalid())
8907       return QualType();
8908 
8909     RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
8910     if (RHS.isInvalid())
8911       return QualType();
8912 
8913     if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() ||
8914         !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType())
8915       return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8916 
8917     return Context.IntTy;
8918   }
8919 
8920   // The following is safe because we only use this method for
8921   // non-overloadable operands.
8922 
8923   // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
8924   // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
8925   // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
8926   ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get());
8927   if (LHSRes.isInvalid())
8928     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8929   LHS = LHSRes;
8930 
8931   ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get());
8932   if (RHSRes.isInvalid())
8933     return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8934   RHS = RHSRes;
8935 
8936   // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
8937   // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
8938   // The result is a bool.
8939   return Context.BoolTy;
8940 }
8941 
8942 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
8943   const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
8944   if (!ME) return false;
8945   if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false;
8946   ObjCMessageExpr *Base =
8947     dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
8948   if (!Base) return false;
8949   return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr;
8950 }
8951 
8952 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a
8953 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become
8954 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block?
8955 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda };
8956 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
8957   assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified());
8958   E = E->IgnoreParens();
8959 
8960   // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope.
8961   DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
8962   if (!DRE) return NCCK_None;
8963   if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None;
8964 
8965   // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'.
8966   VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
8967   if (!var) return NCCK_None;
8968   if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None;
8969   assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?");
8970 
8971   // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda.
8972   DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr;
8973   while (DC != var->getDeclContext()) {
8974     Prev = DC;
8975     DC = DC->getParent();
8976   }
8977   // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far.
8978   if (!var->isInitCapture())
8979     DC = Prev;
8980   return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda);
8981 }
8982 
8983 static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) {
8984   Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType();
8985   if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType())
8986     Ty = Ty->getPointeeType();
8987   return !Ty.isConstQualified();
8988 }
8989 
8990 /// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give
8991 /// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing
8992 /// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or
8993 /// that the function is returning a const reference.
8994 static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E,
8995                                     SourceLocation Loc) {
8996   // Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const
8997   // when this enum is changed.
8998   enum {
8999     ConstFunction,
9000     ConstVariable,
9001     ConstMember,
9002     ConstMethod,
9003     ConstUnknown,  // Keep as last element
9004   };
9005 
9006   SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange();
9007 
9008   // Only emit one error on the first const found.  All other consts will emit
9009   // a note to the error.
9010   bool DiagnosticEmitted = false;
9011 
9012   // Track if the current expression is the result of a derefence, and if the
9013   // next checked expression is the result of a derefence.
9014   bool IsDereference = false;
9015   bool NextIsDereference = false;
9016 
9017   // Loop to process MemberExpr chains.
9018   while (true) {
9019     IsDereference = NextIsDereference;
9020     NextIsDereference = false;
9021 
9022     E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9023     if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
9024       NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow();
9025       const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl();
9026       if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
9027         // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const.
9028         if (Field->isMutable()) {
9029           assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted.");
9030           break;
9031         }
9032 
9033         if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) {
9034           if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9035             S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
9036                 << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field
9037                 << Field->getType();
9038             DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9039           }
9040           S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9041               << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType()
9042               << Field->getSourceRange();
9043         }
9044         E = ME->getBase();
9045         continue;
9046       } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) {
9047         if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) {
9048           if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9049             S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
9050                 << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl
9051                 << VDecl->getType();
9052             DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9053           }
9054           S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9055               << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType()
9056               << VDecl->getSourceRange();
9057         }
9058         // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents.
9059         break;
9060       }
9061       break;
9062     } // End MemberExpr
9063     break;
9064   }
9065 
9066   if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
9067     // Function calls
9068     const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee();
9069     if (!IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) {
9070       if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9071         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
9072                                                       << ConstFunction << FD;
9073         DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9074       }
9075       S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(),
9076              diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9077           << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType()
9078           << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
9079     }
9080   } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
9081     // Point to variable declaration.
9082     if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) {
9083       if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) {
9084         if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9085           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
9086               << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType();
9087           DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9088         }
9089         S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9090             << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange();
9091       }
9092     }
9093   } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) {
9094     if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) {
9095       if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
9096         if (MD->isConst()) {
9097           if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9098             S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
9099                                                           << ConstMethod << MD;
9100             DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9101           }
9102           S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9103               << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange();
9104         }
9105       }
9106     }
9107   }
9108 
9109   if (DiagnosticEmitted)
9110     return;
9111 
9112   // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error.
9113   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown;
9114 }
9115 
9116 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue.  If not,
9117 /// emit an error and return true.  If so, return false.
9118 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
9119   assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
9120   SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
9121   Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
9122                                                               &Loc);
9123   if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S))
9124     IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression;
9125   if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
9126     return false;
9127 
9128   unsigned DiagID = 0;
9129   bool NeedType = false;
9130   switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
9131   case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified:
9132     // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object
9133     // from an enclosing function or block.
9134     if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) {
9135       if (NCCK == NCCK_Block)
9136         DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9137       else
9138         DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9139       break;
9140     }
9141 
9142     // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we
9143     // infer 'const'.  These are always pseudo-strong variables.
9144     if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
9145       DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
9146       if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) {
9147         VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl());
9148 
9149         // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the
9150         // user actually wrote 'const'.
9151         if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() &&
9152             (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() ||
9153              !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) {
9154           // There are two pseudo-strong cases:
9155           //  - self
9156           ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl();
9157           if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl())
9158             DiagID = method->isClassMethod()
9159               ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method
9160               : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self;
9161 
9162           //  - fast enumeration variables
9163           else
9164             DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration;
9165 
9166           SourceRange Assign;
9167           if (Loc != OrigLoc)
9168             Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
9169           S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
9170           // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool
9171           // can do its job.
9172           return false;
9173         }
9174       }
9175     }
9176 
9177     // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a
9178     // simple const assignment.
9179     if (DiagID == 0) {
9180       DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
9181       return true;
9182     }
9183 
9184     break;
9185   case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
9186   case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary:
9187     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9188     NeedType = true;
9189     break;
9190   case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
9191     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9192     NeedType = true;
9193     break;
9194   case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
9195     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
9196     break;
9197   case Expr::MLV_Valid:
9198     llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
9199   case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
9200   case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
9201   case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
9202     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9203     break;
9204   case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
9205   case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
9206     return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
9207              diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E);
9208   case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
9209     DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
9210     break;
9211   case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
9212     llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently");
9213   case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression:
9214     DiagID = diag::error_readonly_message_assignment;
9215     break;
9216   case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
9217     DiagID = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
9218     break;
9219   }
9220 
9221   SourceRange Assign;
9222   if (Loc != OrigLoc)
9223     Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
9224   if (NeedType)
9225     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
9226   else
9227     S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
9228   return true;
9229 }
9230 
9231 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
9232                                          SourceLocation Loc,
9233                                          Sema &Sema) {
9234   // C / C++ fields
9235   MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr);
9236   MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr);
9237   if (ML && MR && ML->getMemberDecl() == MR->getMemberDecl()) {
9238     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase()))
9239       Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0;
9240   }
9241 
9242   // Objective-C instance variables
9243   ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
9244   ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
9245   if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) {
9246     DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
9247     DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
9248     if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl())
9249       Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1;
9250   }
9251 }
9252 
9253 // C99 6.5.16.1
9254 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS,
9255                                        SourceLocation Loc,
9256                                        QualType CompoundType) {
9257   assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
9258 
9259   // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
9260   if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this))
9261     return QualType();
9262 
9263   QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType();
9264   QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() :
9265                                              CompoundType;
9266   AssignConvertType ConvTy;
9267   if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
9268     Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get();
9269 
9270     CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this);
9271 
9272     QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
9273     ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
9274     if (RHS.isInvalid())
9275       return QualType();
9276     // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
9277     if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
9278         ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
9279           RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
9280          (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
9281           LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
9282       ConvTy = Compatible;
9283 
9284     if (ConvTy == Compatible &&
9285         LHSType->isObjCObjectType())
9286         Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment)
9287           << LHSType;
9288 
9289     // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
9290     // right next to each other.  If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
9291     // instead of "x += 4".
9292     if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
9293       RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
9294     if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
9295       if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
9296            UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
9297           Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
9298           // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
9299           Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
9300           // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
9301           // unary +/-.  We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
9302           Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
9303           UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
9304         Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
9305           << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
9306           << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
9307       }
9308     }
9309 
9310     if (ConvTy == Compatible) {
9311       if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) {
9312         // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but
9313         // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is
9314         // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference!
9315         const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
9316         const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS);
9317         if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
9318           checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get());
9319 
9320         // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
9321         // Although this code can still have problems:
9322         //   id x = self.weakProp;
9323         //   id y = self.weakProp;
9324         // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
9325         // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
9326         // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
9327         if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
9328                              RHS.get()->getLocStart()))
9329           getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get());
9330 
9331       } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
9332         checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get());
9333       }
9334     }
9335   } else {
9336     // Compound assignment "x += y"
9337     ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType);
9338   }
9339 
9340   if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
9341                                RHS.get(), AA_Assigning))
9342     return QualType();
9343 
9344   CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr);
9345 
9346   // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
9347   // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
9348   // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
9349   // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
9350   // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
9351   // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
9352   // operand.
9353   return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
9354           ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
9355 }
9356 
9357 // C99 6.5.17
9358 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
9359                                    SourceLocation Loc) {
9360   LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
9361   RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
9362   if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
9363     return QualType();
9364 
9365   // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
9366   // operands, but not unary promotions.
9367   // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
9368 
9369   // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the
9370   // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS.
9371   LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get());
9372   if (LHS.isInvalid())
9373     return QualType();
9374 
9375   S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get());
9376 
9377   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9378     RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
9379     if (RHS.isInvalid())
9380       return QualType();
9381     if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType())
9382       S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(),
9383                             diag::err_incomplete_type);
9384   }
9385 
9386   return RHS.get()->getType();
9387 }
9388 
9389 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
9390 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
9391 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op,
9392                                                ExprValueKind &VK,
9393                                                ExprObjectKind &OK,
9394                                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
9395                                                bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) {
9396   if (Op->isTypeDependent())
9397     return S.Context.DependentTy;
9398 
9399   QualType ResType = Op->getType();
9400   // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic
9401   // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of
9402   // checking.
9403   if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
9404     ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
9405 
9406   assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
9407 
9408   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
9409     // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
9410     if (!IsInc) {
9411       S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
9412       return QualType();
9413     }
9414     // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
9415     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
9416   } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) {
9417     // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode
9418     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType;
9419     return QualType();
9420   } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
9421     // OK!
9422   } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) {
9423     // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
9424     if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op))
9425       return QualType();
9426   } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9427     // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden.
9428     // Otherwise, we just need a complete type.
9429     if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) ||
9430         checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op))
9431       return QualType();
9432   } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
9433     // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
9434     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
9435       << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
9436   } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
9437     ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
9438     if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9439     return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc,
9440                                           IsInc, IsPrefix);
9441   } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) {
9442     // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 )
9443   } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() &&
9444             ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
9445     // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types.
9446   } else {
9447     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
9448       << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
9449     return QualType();
9450   }
9451   // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
9452   // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
9453   if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S))
9454     return QualType();
9455   // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
9456   // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
9457   // operand.
9458   if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9459     VK = VK_LValue;
9460     OK = Op->getObjectKind();
9461     return ResType;
9462   } else {
9463     VK = VK_RValue;
9464     return ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
9465   }
9466 }
9467 
9468 
9469 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
9470 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
9471 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
9472 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
9473 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
9474 ///  - &(x) => x
9475 ///  - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
9476 ///  - &s.xx => s
9477 ///  - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
9478 ///  - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
9479 ///  - &"123"[2] -> 0
9480 ///  - & __real__ x -> x
9481 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
9482   switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
9483   case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
9484     return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
9485   case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
9486     // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
9487     // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
9488     // irrelevant.
9489     if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
9490       return nullptr;
9491     // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
9492     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
9493   case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
9494     // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary!  We should catch the implicit
9495     // promotion of register arrays earlier.
9496     Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
9497     if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
9498       if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
9499         return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
9500     }
9501     return nullptr;
9502   }
9503   case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
9504     UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
9505 
9506     switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
9507     case UO_Real:
9508     case UO_Imag:
9509     case UO_Extension:
9510       return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
9511     default:
9512       return nullptr;
9513     }
9514   }
9515   case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
9516     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
9517   case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
9518     // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
9519     // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
9520     return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
9521   default:
9522     return nullptr;
9523   }
9524 }
9525 
9526 namespace {
9527   enum {
9528     AO_Bit_Field = 0,
9529     AO_Vector_Element = 1,
9530     AO_Property_Expansion = 2,
9531     AO_Register_Variable = 3,
9532     AO_No_Error = 4
9533   };
9534 }
9535 /// \brief Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations.
9536 ///
9537 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken.
9538 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9539                                          Expr *E, unsigned Type) {
9540   S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange();
9541 }
9542 
9543 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
9544 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
9545 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
9546 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
9547 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
9548 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
9549 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
9550 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9551   if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){
9552     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
9553       Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
9554       if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) {
9555         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf);
9556         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function)
9557           << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9558         return QualType();
9559       }
9560 
9561       OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E);
9562       if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl))
9563         if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) {
9564           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9565             << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9566           return QualType();
9567         }
9568 
9569       return Context.OverloadTy;
9570     }
9571 
9572     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny)
9573       return Context.UnknownAnyTy;
9574 
9575     if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) {
9576       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9577         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9578       return QualType();
9579     }
9580 
9581     OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get());
9582     if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9583   }
9584 
9585   if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent())
9586     return Context.DependentTy;
9587 
9588   assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType());
9589 
9590   // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
9591   Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
9592 
9593   // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed.
9594   if (LangOpts.OpenCL && op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
9595     Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address);
9596     return QualType();
9597   }
9598 
9599   if (getLangOpts().C99) {
9600     // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
9601     if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
9602       if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
9603         // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
9604         // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
9605         return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
9606     }
9607     // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
9608     // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
9609   }
9610   ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
9611   Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context);
9612   unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error;
9613 
9614   if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) {
9615     bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext();
9616     Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary
9617                                   : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary)
9618       << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
9619     if (sfinae)
9620       return QualType();
9621     // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address.
9622     OrigOp = op = new (Context)
9623         MaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true);
9624   } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
9625     return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
9626   } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
9627     // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
9628     // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
9629 
9630     // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
9631     if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
9632       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9633         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9634       return QualType();
9635     }
9636     DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
9637     CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
9638 
9639     // The id-expression was parenthesized.
9640     if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) {
9641       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
9642         << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9643 
9644     // The method was named without a qualifier.
9645     } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
9646       if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty())
9647         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
9648           << op->getSourceRange();
9649       else {
9650         SmallString<32> Str;
9651         StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str);
9652         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
9653           << op->getSourceRange()
9654           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual);
9655       }
9656     }
9657 
9658     // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2.
9659     if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD))
9660       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange();
9661 
9662     QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
9663         op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
9664     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9665       RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0);
9666     return MPTy;
9667   } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
9668     // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9669     // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
9670     if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
9671       // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references.
9672       if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) {
9673         AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
9674       } else {
9675         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
9676           << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
9677         return QualType();
9678       }
9679     }
9680   } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9681     // The operand cannot be a bit-field
9682     AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field;
9683   } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) {
9684     // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
9685     AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element;
9686   } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9687     // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
9688     // with the register storage-class specifier.
9689     if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
9690       // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
9691       // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
9692       if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
9693           !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9694         AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable;
9695       }
9696     } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) {
9697       AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
9698     } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
9699       return Context.OverloadTy;
9700     } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) {
9701       // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
9702       // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
9703       // scope qualifier for the class.
9704       if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
9705         DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
9706         if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
9707           if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
9708             Diag(OpLoc,
9709                  diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
9710               << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType();
9711             return QualType();
9712           }
9713 
9714           while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
9715             Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
9716 
9717           QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
9718               op->getType(),
9719               Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
9720           if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9721             RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0);
9722           return MPTy;
9723         }
9724       }
9725     } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl))
9726       llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type");
9727   }
9728 
9729   if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) {
9730     diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError);
9731     return QualType();
9732   }
9733 
9734   if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
9735     // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
9736     // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
9737     // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
9738     Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
9739   }
9740 
9741   // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
9742   if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
9743     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
9744   return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
9745 }
9746 
9747 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) {
9748   const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp);
9749   if (!DRE)
9750     return;
9751   const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl();
9752   if (!D)
9753     return;
9754   const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D);
9755   if (!Param)
9756     return;
9757   if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext()))
9758     if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>())
9759       return;
9760   if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction())
9761     if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param))
9762       FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param);
9763 }
9764 
9765 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
9766 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK,
9767                                         SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9768   if (Op->isTypeDependent())
9769     return S.Context.DependentTy;
9770 
9771   ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
9772   if (ConvResult.isInvalid())
9773     return QualType();
9774   Op = ConvResult.get();
9775   QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
9776   QualType Result;
9777 
9778   if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) {
9779     QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType();
9780     S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true,
9781                                      Op->getSourceRange());
9782   }
9783 
9784   if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
9785     Result = PT->getPointeeType();
9786   else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
9787              OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
9788     Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
9789   else {
9790     ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
9791     if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9792     if (PR.get() != Op)
9793       return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc);
9794   }
9795 
9796   if (Result.isNull()) {
9797     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
9798       << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
9799     return QualType();
9800   }
9801 
9802   // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result
9803   // is an incomplete type or void.  It would be possible to warn about
9804   // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
9805   // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid
9806   // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type:
9807   //
9808   // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1:
9809   //   [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall
9810   //   be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type
9811   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType())
9812     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer)
9813       << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
9814 
9815   // Dereferences are usually l-values...
9816   VK = VK_LValue;
9817 
9818   // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C.
9819   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType())
9820     VK = VK_RValue;
9821 
9822   return Result;
9823 }
9824 
9825 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) {
9826   BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
9827   switch (Kind) {
9828   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
9829   case tok::periodstar:           Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
9830   case tok::arrowstar:            Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
9831   case tok::star:                 Opc = BO_Mul; break;
9832   case tok::slash:                Opc = BO_Div; break;
9833   case tok::percent:              Opc = BO_Rem; break;
9834   case tok::plus:                 Opc = BO_Add; break;
9835   case tok::minus:                Opc = BO_Sub; break;
9836   case tok::lessless:             Opc = BO_Shl; break;
9837   case tok::greatergreater:       Opc = BO_Shr; break;
9838   case tok::lessequal:            Opc = BO_LE; break;
9839   case tok::less:                 Opc = BO_LT; break;
9840   case tok::greaterequal:         Opc = BO_GE; break;
9841   case tok::greater:              Opc = BO_GT; break;
9842   case tok::exclaimequal:         Opc = BO_NE; break;
9843   case tok::equalequal:           Opc = BO_EQ; break;
9844   case tok::amp:                  Opc = BO_And; break;
9845   case tok::caret:                Opc = BO_Xor; break;
9846   case tok::pipe:                 Opc = BO_Or; break;
9847   case tok::ampamp:               Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
9848   case tok::pipepipe:             Opc = BO_LOr; break;
9849   case tok::equal:                Opc = BO_Assign; break;
9850   case tok::starequal:            Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
9851   case tok::slashequal:           Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
9852   case tok::percentequal:         Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
9853   case tok::plusequal:            Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
9854   case tok::minusequal:           Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
9855   case tok::lesslessequal:        Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
9856   case tok::greatergreaterequal:  Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
9857   case tok::ampequal:             Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
9858   case tok::caretequal:           Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
9859   case tok::pipeequal:            Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
9860   case tok::comma:                Opc = BO_Comma; break;
9861   }
9862   return Opc;
9863 }
9864 
9865 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
9866   tok::TokenKind Kind) {
9867   UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
9868   switch (Kind) {
9869   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
9870   case tok::plusplus:     Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
9871   case tok::minusminus:   Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
9872   case tok::amp:          Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
9873   case tok::star:         Opc = UO_Deref; break;
9874   case tok::plus:         Opc = UO_Plus; break;
9875   case tok::minus:        Opc = UO_Minus; break;
9876   case tok::tilde:        Opc = UO_Not; break;
9877   case tok::exclaim:      Opc = UO_LNot; break;
9878   case tok::kw___real:    Opc = UO_Real; break;
9879   case tok::kw___imag:    Opc = UO_Imag; break;
9880   case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
9881   }
9882   return Opc;
9883 }
9884 
9885 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself.
9886 /// This warning is only emitted for builtin assignment operations. It is also
9887 /// suppressed in the event of macro expansions.
9888 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
9889                                    SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9890   if (!S.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty())
9891     return;
9892   if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID())
9893     return;
9894   LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9895   RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9896   const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
9897   const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
9898   if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef ||
9899       LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() ||
9900       RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID())
9901     return;
9902   const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
9903     cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
9904   const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
9905     cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
9906   if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
9907     return;
9908   if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
9909     return;
9910   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9911     if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
9912       return;
9913 
9914   S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_self_assignment)
9915       << LHSDeclRef->getType()
9916       << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
9917 }
9918 
9919 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer.  This
9920 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer.
9921 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R,
9922                                           SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9923   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1)
9924     return;
9925 
9926   const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr;
9927   const Expr *LHS = L.get();
9928   const Expr *RHS = R.get();
9929 
9930   if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9931     ObjCPointerExpr = LHS;
9932     OtherExpr = RHS;
9933   }
9934   else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9935     ObjCPointerExpr = RHS;
9936     OtherExpr = LHS;
9937   }
9938 
9939   // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false
9940   // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing.  This logic mainly
9941   // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which
9942   // code should generally never do.
9943   if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
9944     unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking;
9945     // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX.
9946     const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
9947     // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which
9948     // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value.
9949     // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase.
9950     if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) {
9951       Selector S = ME->getSelector();
9952       StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0);
9953       if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector"))
9954         Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector;
9955     }
9956 
9957     S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag)
9958       << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
9959   }
9960 }
9961 
9962 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) {
9963   if (!E)
9964     return nullptr;
9965   if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
9966     return DRE->getDecl();
9967   if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
9968     return ME->getMemberDecl();
9969   if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E))
9970     return IRE->getDecl();
9971   return nullptr;
9972 }
9973 
9974 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
9975 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
9976 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
9977 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
9978                                     BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
9979                                     Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
9980   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) {
9981     // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment,
9982     // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for
9983     // non-assignment operators.
9984     // C++11 5.17p9:
9985     //   The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning
9986     //   of x = {} is x = T().
9987     InitializationKind Kind =
9988         InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(RHSExpr->getLocStart());
9989     InitializedEntity Entity =
9990         InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType());
9991     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
9992     ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
9993     if (Init.isInvalid())
9994       return Init;
9995     RHSExpr = Init.get();
9996   }
9997 
9998   ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
9999   QualType ResultTy;     // Result type of the binary operator.
10000   // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
10001   QualType CompLHSTy;    // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
10002   QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
10003   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
10004   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
10005 
10006   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10007     // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
10008     // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
10009     // been dealt with before checking the operands.
10010     LHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr);
10011     RHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) {
10012       if (Opc != BO_Assign)
10013         return ExprResult(E);
10014       // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS.
10015       Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E);
10016       return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E;
10017     });
10018     if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable())
10019       return ExprError();
10020   }
10021 
10022   switch (Opc) {
10023   case BO_Assign:
10024     ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType());
10025     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
10026         LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
10027       VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind();
10028       OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
10029     }
10030     if (!ResultTy.isNull()) {
10031       DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
10032       DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
10033     }
10034     RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get());
10035     break;
10036   case BO_PtrMemD:
10037   case BO_PtrMemI:
10038     ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc,
10039                                             Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
10040     break;
10041   case BO_Mul:
10042   case BO_Div:
10043     ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false,
10044                                            Opc == BO_Div);
10045     break;
10046   case BO_Rem:
10047     ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10048     break;
10049   case BO_Add:
10050     ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
10051     break;
10052   case BO_Sub:
10053     ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10054     break;
10055   case BO_Shl:
10056   case BO_Shr:
10057     ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
10058     break;
10059   case BO_LE:
10060   case BO_LT:
10061   case BO_GE:
10062   case BO_GT:
10063     ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
10064     break;
10065   case BO_EQ:
10066   case BO_NE:
10067     ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, false);
10068     break;
10069   case BO_And:
10070     checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10071   case BO_Xor:
10072   case BO_Or:
10073     ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10074     break;
10075   case BO_LAnd:
10076   case BO_LOr:
10077     ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
10078     break;
10079   case BO_MulAssign:
10080   case BO_DivAssign:
10081     CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true,
10082                                                Opc == BO_DivAssign);
10083     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10084     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10085       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10086     break;
10087   case BO_RemAssign:
10088     CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
10089     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10090     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10091       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10092     break;
10093   case BO_AddAssign:
10094     CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy);
10095     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10096       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10097     break;
10098   case BO_SubAssign:
10099     CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
10100     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10101       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10102     break;
10103   case BO_ShlAssign:
10104   case BO_ShrAssign:
10105     CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
10106     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10107     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10108       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10109     break;
10110   case BO_AndAssign:
10111   case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough
10112 	  DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
10113   case BO_XorAssign:
10114     CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
10115     CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10116     if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10117       ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10118     break;
10119   case BO_Comma:
10120     ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10121     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) {
10122       VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind();
10123       OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind();
10124     }
10125     break;
10126   }
10127   if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
10128     return ExprError();
10129 
10130   // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator
10131   CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get());
10132   CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get());
10133 
10134   if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
10135     NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
10136                                                  &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
10137                                                  SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
10138     if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) {
10139       SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd());
10140       Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) <<
10141       FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") <<
10142       FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), ",") <<
10143       FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
10144     }
10145     else
10146       Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
10147   }
10148   else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
10149            dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()))
10150     DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get());
10151 
10152   if (CompResultTy.isNull())
10153     return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK,
10154                                         OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
10155   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() !=
10156       OK_ObjCProperty) {
10157     VK = VK_LValue;
10158     OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
10159   }
10160   return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
10161       LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
10162       OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
10163 }
10164 
10165 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
10166 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
10167 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
10168 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
10169 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10170                                       SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
10171                                       Expr *RHSExpr) {
10172   BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr);
10173   BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr);
10174 
10175   // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator.
10176   bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp();
10177   bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp();
10178   if (!isLeftComp && !isRightComp)
10179     return;
10180 
10181   // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
10182   // Don't diagnose this.
10183   bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
10184   bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
10185   if ((isLeftComp || isLeftBitwise) && (isRightComp || isRightBitwise))
10186     return;
10187 
10188   SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(),
10189                                                    OpLoc)
10190                                      : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
10191   StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr();
10192   SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ?
10193       SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd())
10194     : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getLocEnd());
10195 
10196   Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
10197     << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr;
10198   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
10199     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr,
10200     (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange());
10201   SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
10202     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
10203       << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
10204     ParensRange);
10205 }
10206 
10207 /// \brief It accepts a '&' expr that is inside a '|' one.
10208 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&' expression
10209 /// in parentheses.
10210 static void
10211 EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10212                                        BinaryOperator *Bop) {
10213   assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And);
10214   Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or)
10215       << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
10216   SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
10217     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
10218       << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
10219     Bop->getSourceRange());
10220 }
10221 
10222 /// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
10223 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
10224 /// in parentheses.
10225 static void
10226 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10227                                        BinaryOperator *Bop) {
10228   assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
10229   Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
10230       << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
10231   SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
10232     Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
10233       << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
10234     Bop->getSourceRange());
10235 }
10236 
10237 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
10238 /// 'true'.
10239 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
10240   bool Res;
10241   return !E->isValueDependent() &&
10242          E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res;
10243 }
10244 
10245 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
10246 /// 'false'.
10247 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
10248   bool Res;
10249   return !E->isValueDependent() &&
10250          E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res;
10251 }
10252 
10253 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
10254 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10255                                              Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10256   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) {
10257     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
10258       // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10259       if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr))
10260         return;
10261       // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10262       if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS()))
10263         return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
10264     } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
10265       if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
10266         // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for
10267         // "a || b && 1", but warn now.
10268         if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS()))
10269           return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
10270       }
10271     }
10272   }
10273 }
10274 
10275 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
10276 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10277                                              Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10278   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) {
10279     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
10280       // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10281       if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr))
10282         return;
10283       // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10284       if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS()))
10285         return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
10286     }
10287   }
10288 }
10289 
10290 /// \brief Look for '&' in the left or right hand of a '|' expr.
10291 static void DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10292                                              Expr *OrArg) {
10293   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrArg)) {
10294     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And)
10295       return EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
10296   }
10297 }
10298 
10299 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10300                                     Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) {
10301   if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) {
10302     if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) {
10303       StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr();
10304       S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift)
10305           << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op;
10306       SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
10307           S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op,
10308           Bop->getSourceRange());
10309     }
10310   }
10311 }
10312 
10313 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10314                                  Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10315   CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr);
10316   if (!OCE)
10317     return;
10318 
10319   FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee();
10320   if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator())
10321     return;
10322 
10323   OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator();
10324   if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater)
10325     return;
10326 
10327   S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison)
10328       << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange()
10329       << (Kind == OO_LessLess);
10330   SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(),
10331                      S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
10332                          << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"),
10333                      OCE->getSourceRange());
10334   SuggestParentheses(S, OpLoc,
10335                      S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first),
10336                      SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getLocStart(),
10337                                  RHSExpr->getLocEnd()));
10338 }
10339 
10340 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
10341 /// precedence.
10342 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10343                                     SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
10344                                     Expr *RHSExpr){
10345   // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
10346   if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
10347     DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10348 
10349   // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3"
10350   if (Opc == BO_Or && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
10351     DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr);
10352     DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr);
10353   }
10354 
10355   // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
10356   // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
10357   if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
10358     DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10359     DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10360   }
10361 
10362   if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext()))
10363       || Opc == BO_Shr) {
10364     StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
10365     DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift);
10366     DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift);
10367   }
10368 
10369   // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as:
10370   // cout << 5 == 4;
10371   if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc))
10372     DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10373 }
10374 
10375 // Binary Operators.  'Tok' is the token for the operator.
10376 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
10377                             tok::TokenKind Kind,
10378                             Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10379   BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
10380   assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
10381   assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
10382 
10383   // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
10384   DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10385 
10386   return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10387 }
10388 
10389 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope.
10390 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10391                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10392                                        Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
10393   // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
10394   // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
10395   // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
10396   // the arguments.
10397   UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
10398   OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp
10399     = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10400   if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal)
10401     S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(),
10402                                    RHS->getType(), Functions);
10403 
10404   // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
10405   // binary operation.
10406   return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS);
10407 }
10408 
10409 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10410                             BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10411                             Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10412   // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment
10413   // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if
10414   // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent),
10415   // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case).  We also want to get
10416   // any placeholder types out of the way.
10417 
10418   // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS.
10419   if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10420     // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis.
10421     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
10422         BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc))
10423       return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10424 
10425     // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
10426     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
10427       // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder,
10428       // though.  Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that
10429       // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set.  Note
10430       // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never
10431       // instantiates to having an overloadable type.
10432       ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
10433       if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10434       RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
10435 
10436       if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
10437           RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10438         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10439     }
10440 
10441     ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr);
10442     if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10443     LHSExpr = LHS.get();
10444   }
10445 
10446   // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS.
10447   if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10448     // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type
10449     // being assigned to.
10450     if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
10451       if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())
10452         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10453 
10454       if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10455         return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10456 
10457       return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10458     }
10459 
10460     // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
10461     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload &&
10462         LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10463       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10464 
10465     ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
10466     if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError();
10467     RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
10468   }
10469 
10470   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10471     // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an
10472     // overloaded op.
10473     if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())
10474       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10475 
10476     // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an
10477     // overloadable type.
10478     if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
10479         RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10480       return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10481   }
10482 
10483   // Build a built-in binary operation.
10484   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10485 }
10486 
10487 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
10488                                       UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
10489                                       Expr *InputExpr) {
10490   ExprResult Input = InputExpr;
10491   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
10492   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
10493   QualType resultType;
10494   switch (Opc) {
10495   case UO_PreInc:
10496   case UO_PreDec:
10497   case UO_PostInc:
10498   case UO_PostDec:
10499     resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK,
10500                                                 OpLoc,
10501                                                 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
10502                                                 Opc == UO_PostInc,
10503                                                 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
10504                                                 Opc == UO_PreDec);
10505     break;
10506   case UO_AddrOf:
10507     resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
10508     RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr);
10509     break;
10510   case UO_Deref: {
10511     Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10512     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10513     resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc);
10514     break;
10515   }
10516   case UO_Plus:
10517   case UO_Minus:
10518     Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
10519     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10520     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10521     if (resultType->isDependentType())
10522       break;
10523     if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
10524         resultType->isVectorType())
10525       break;
10526     else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
10527              Opc == UO_Plus &&
10528              resultType->isPointerType())
10529       break;
10530 
10531     return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10532       << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10533 
10534   case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
10535     Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
10536     if (Input.isInvalid())
10537       return ExprError();
10538     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10539     if (resultType->isDependentType())
10540       break;
10541     // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
10542     if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
10543       // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
10544       Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
10545           << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange();
10546     else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
10547       break;
10548     else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
10549       if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
10550         // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate
10551         // on vector float types.
10552         QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
10553         if (!T->isIntegerType())
10554           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10555                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10556       }
10557       break;
10558     } else {
10559       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10560                        << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10561     }
10562     break;
10563 
10564   case UO_LNot: // logical negation
10565     // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
10566     Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10567     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10568     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10569 
10570     // Though we still have to promote half FP to float...
10571     if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) {
10572       Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
10573       resultType = Context.FloatTy;
10574     }
10575 
10576     if (resultType->isDependentType())
10577       break;
10578     if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) {
10579       // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough;
10580       if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10581         // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9:
10582         // operand contextually converted to bool.
10583         Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy,
10584                                   ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType));
10585       } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10586                  Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
10587         // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
10588         // operate on scalar float types.
10589         if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
10590           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10591                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10592       }
10593     } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
10594       if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10595           Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
10596         // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
10597         // operate on vector float types.
10598         QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
10599         if (!T->isIntegerType())
10600           return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10601                            << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10602       }
10603       // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type.
10604       resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType);
10605       break;
10606     } else {
10607       return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10608         << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10609     }
10610 
10611     // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
10612     // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
10613     resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
10614     break;
10615   case UO_Real:
10616   case UO_Imag:
10617     resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
10618     // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary
10619     // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values.
10620     if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10621     if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) {
10622       if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue &&
10623           Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
10624         VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
10625     } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10626       // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not.
10627       Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10628     }
10629     break;
10630   case UO_Extension:
10631     resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10632     VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
10633     OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind();
10634     break;
10635   }
10636   if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid())
10637     return ExprError();
10638 
10639   // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator,
10640   // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially
10641   // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize]
10642   // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard).
10643   if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref)
10644     CheckArrayAccess(Input.get());
10645 
10646   return new (Context)
10647       UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc);
10648 }
10649 
10650 /// \brief Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member
10651 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member
10652 /// with the address-of operator.
10653 static bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) {
10654   if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
10655     if (!DRE->getQualifier())
10656       return false;
10657 
10658     ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl();
10659     if (!VD->isCXXClassMember())
10660       return false;
10661 
10662     if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
10663       return true;
10664     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD))
10665       return Method->isInstance();
10666 
10667     return false;
10668   }
10669 
10670   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
10671     if (!ULE->getQualifier())
10672       return false;
10673 
10674     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator D = ULE->decls_begin(),
10675                                            DEnd = ULE->decls_end();
10676          D != DEnd; ++D) {
10677       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(*D)) {
10678         if (Method->isInstance())
10679           return true;
10680       } else {
10681         // Overload set does not contain methods.
10682         break;
10683       }
10684     }
10685 
10686     return false;
10687   }
10688 
10689   return false;
10690 }
10691 
10692 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10693                               UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) {
10694   // First things first: handle placeholders so that the
10695   // overloaded-operator check considers the right type.
10696   if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10697     // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references.
10698     if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
10699         UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc))
10700       return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10701 
10702     // extension is always a builtin operator.
10703     if (Opc == UO_Extension)
10704       return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10705 
10706     // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder.
10707     // The builtin code knows what to do.
10708     if (Opc == UO_AddrOf &&
10709         (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload ||
10710          pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny ||
10711          pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember))
10712       return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10713 
10714     // Anything else needs to be handled now.
10715     ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input);
10716     if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10717     Input = Result.get();
10718   }
10719 
10720   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
10721       UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None &&
10722       !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) {
10723     // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
10724     // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
10725     // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
10726     // the arguments.
10727     UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
10728     OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10729     if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
10730       LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
10731                                    Functions);
10732 
10733     return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
10734   }
10735 
10736   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10737 }
10738 
10739 // Unary Operators.  'Tok' is the token for the operator.
10740 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10741                               tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
10742   return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
10743 }
10744 
10745 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
10746 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc,
10747                                 LabelDecl *TheDecl) {
10748   TheDecl->markUsed(Context);
10749   // Create the AST node.  The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
10750   return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl,
10751                                      Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy));
10752 }
10753 
10754 /// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether
10755 /// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an
10756 /// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the
10757 /// release out of the full-expression.  Otherwise, return null.
10758 /// Cannot fail.
10759 static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) {
10760   // Should always be wrapped with one of these.
10761   ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement);
10762   if (!cleanups) return nullptr;
10763 
10764   ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr());
10765   if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject)
10766     return nullptr;
10767 
10768   // Splice out the cast.  This shouldn't modify any interesting
10769   // features of the statement.
10770   Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr();
10771   assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType());
10772   assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind());
10773   cleanups->setSubExpr(producer);
10774   return cleanups;
10775 }
10776 
10777 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() {
10778   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
10779 }
10780 
10781 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() {
10782   // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a
10783   // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything.
10784 
10785   DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10786   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10787 }
10788 
10789 ExprResult
10790 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
10791                     SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
10792   assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
10793   CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
10794 
10795   if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
10796     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10797   assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!");
10798   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10799 
10800   // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
10801   // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
10802   // More semantic analysis is needed.
10803 
10804   // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
10805   // as the type of the stmtexpr.
10806   QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
10807   bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
10808   if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
10809     Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
10810     LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = nullptr;
10811     // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
10812     while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
10813       LastLabelStmt = Label;
10814       LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
10815     }
10816 
10817     if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
10818       // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not
10819       // lvalue-to-rvalue.  However, initialize an unqualified type.
10820       ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE);
10821       if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
10822         return ExprError();
10823       Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10824 
10825       if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) {
10826         // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice
10827         // the consume out and bind it later.  In the alternate case
10828         // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result
10829         // initialization will create a produce.  In both cases the
10830         // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with
10831         // a bind.
10832         if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt
10833               = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) {
10834           LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt;
10835         } else {
10836           LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization(
10837                             InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
10838                                                                 Ty,
10839                                                                 false),
10840                                                    SourceLocation(),
10841                                                LastExpr);
10842         }
10843 
10844         if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
10845           return ExprError();
10846         if (LastExpr.get() != nullptr) {
10847           if (!LastLabelStmt)
10848             Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.get());
10849           else
10850             LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.get());
10851           StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
10852         }
10853       }
10854     }
10855   }
10856 
10857   // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
10858   // expressions are not lvalues.
10859   Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
10860   if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
10861     return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
10862   return ResStmtExpr;
10863 }
10864 
10865 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
10866                                       TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
10867                                       OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
10868                                       unsigned NumComponents,
10869                                       SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
10870   QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
10871   bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
10872   SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
10873 
10874   // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
10875   // one is known to be a field designator.  Verify that the ArgTy represents
10876   // a struct/union/class.
10877   if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
10878     return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
10879                        << ArgTy << TypeRange);
10880 
10881   // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
10882   // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
10883   if (!Dependent
10884       && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
10885                              diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange))
10886     return ExprError();
10887 
10888   // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
10889   // GCC extension, diagnose them.
10890   // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
10891   // a system header!
10892   if (NumComponents != 1)
10893     Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
10894       << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
10895 
10896   bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
10897   QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
10898   typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
10899   SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
10900   SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
10901   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
10902     const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
10903     if (OC.isBrackets) {
10904       // Offset of an array sub-field.  TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
10905       if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
10906         const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
10907         if(!AT)
10908           return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
10909                            << CurrentType);
10910         CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
10911       } else
10912         CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
10913 
10914       ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E));
10915       if (IdxRval.isInvalid())
10916         return ExprError();
10917       Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get();
10918 
10919       // The expression must be an integral expression.
10920       // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
10921       if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
10922           !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
10923         return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
10924                               diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
10925                          << Idx->getSourceRange());
10926 
10927       // Record this array index.
10928       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
10929       Exprs.push_back(Idx);
10930       continue;
10931     }
10932 
10933     // Offset of a field.
10934     if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
10935       // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
10936       // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
10937       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
10938       CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
10939       continue;
10940     }
10941 
10942     // We need to have a complete type to look into.
10943     if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
10944                             diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
10945       return ExprError();
10946 
10947     // Look for the designated field.
10948     const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
10949     if (!RC)
10950       return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
10951                        << CurrentType);
10952     RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
10953 
10954     // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
10955     //   The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
10956     //   International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
10957     //   (clause 9).
10958     // C++11 [support.types]p4:
10959     //   If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are
10960     //   undefined.
10961     if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
10962       bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD();
10963       unsigned DiagID =
10964         LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type
10965                             : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type;
10966 
10967       if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
10968           DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr,
10969                               PDiag(DiagID)
10970                               << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
10971                               << CurrentType))
10972         DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
10973     }
10974 
10975     // Look for the field.
10976     LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
10977     LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
10978     FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
10979     IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr;
10980     if (!MemberDecl) {
10981       if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>()))
10982         MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField();
10983     }
10984 
10985     if (!MemberDecl)
10986       return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
10987                        << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
10988                                                               OC.LocEnd));
10989 
10990     // C99 7.17p3:
10991     //   (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
10992     //
10993     // We diagnose this as an error.
10994     if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) {
10995       Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
10996         << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
10997         << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
10998       Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
10999       return ExprError();
11000     }
11001 
11002     RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
11003     if (IndirectMemberDecl)
11004       Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext());
11005 
11006     // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
11007     // the base class indirections.
11008     CXXBasePaths Paths;
11009     if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
11010       if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
11011         Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base)
11012           << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
11013           << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
11014         return ExprError();
11015       }
11016 
11017       CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
11018       for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
11019            B != BEnd; ++B)
11020         Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
11021     }
11022 
11023     if (IndirectMemberDecl) {
11024       for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) {
11025         assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI));
11026         Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart,
11027                                      cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd));
11028       }
11029     } else
11030       Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
11031 
11032     CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
11033   }
11034 
11035   return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo,
11036                               Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc);
11037 }
11038 
11039 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
11040                                       SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11041                                       SourceLocation TypeLoc,
11042                                       ParsedType ParsedArgTy,
11043                                       OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
11044                                       unsigned NumComponents,
11045                                       SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
11046 
11047   TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
11048   QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo);
11049   if (ArgTy.isNull())
11050     return ExprError();
11051 
11052   if (!ArgTInfo)
11053     ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
11054 
11055   return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
11056                               RParenLoc);
11057 }
11058 
11059 
11060 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11061                                  Expr *CondExpr,
11062                                  Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
11063                                  SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11064   assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
11065 
11066   ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
11067   ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
11068   QualType resType;
11069   bool ValueDependent = false;
11070   bool CondIsTrue = false;
11071   if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
11072     resType = Context.DependentTy;
11073     ValueDependent = true;
11074   } else {
11075     // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
11076     llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
11077     ExprResult CondICE
11078       = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval,
11079           diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false);
11080     if (CondICE.isInvalid())
11081       return ExprError();
11082     CondExpr = CondICE.get();
11083     CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue();
11084 
11085     // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
11086     Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr;
11087 
11088     resType = ActiveExpr->getType();
11089     ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent();
11090     VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind();
11091     OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind();
11092   }
11093 
11094   return new (Context)
11095       ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc,
11096                  CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent);
11097 }
11098 
11099 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11100 // Clang Extensions.
11101 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11102 
11103 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
11104 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
11105   BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
11106 
11107   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) {
11108     Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
11109     if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx =
11110             getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(),
11111                                           ManglingContextDecl)) {
11112       unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block);
11113       Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl);
11114     }
11115   }
11116 
11117   PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block);
11118   CurContext->addDecl(Block);
11119   if (CurScope)
11120     PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block);
11121   else
11122     CurContext = Block;
11123 
11124   getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true;
11125 
11126   // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any
11127   // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression.
11128   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(PotentiallyEvaluated);
11129 }
11130 
11131 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo,
11132                                Scope *CurScope) {
11133   assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
11134          "block-id should have no identifier!");
11135   assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == Declarator::BlockLiteralContext);
11136   BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
11137 
11138   TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
11139   QualType T = Sig->getType();
11140 
11141   // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would,
11142   // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs.
11143   if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) {
11144     // Drop the parameters.
11145     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
11146     EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
11147     EPI.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const;
11148     T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI);
11149     Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
11150   }
11151 
11152   // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block
11153   // literal signature.  Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType
11154   // unless the function was written with a typedef.
11155   assert(T->isFunctionType() &&
11156          "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature");
11157 
11158   // Look for an explicit signature in that function type.
11159   FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature;
11160 
11161   TypeLoc tmp = Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens();
11162   if ((ExplicitSignature = tmp.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) {
11163 
11164     // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by
11165     // GetTypeForDeclarator.  If so, don't save that as part of the
11166     // written signature.
11167     if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() ==
11168         ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) {
11169       // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of
11170       // TypeSourceInfos.
11171       TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc();
11172       unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize();
11173       Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size);
11174       Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size);
11175 
11176       ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc();
11177     }
11178   }
11179 
11180   CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
11181   CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
11182 
11183   const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>();
11184   QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType();
11185   bool isVariadic =
11186     (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic());
11187 
11188   CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
11189 
11190   // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
11191   // return type.  TODO:  what should we do with declarators like:
11192   //   ^ * { ... }
11193   // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
11194   if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) {
11195     CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
11196     CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false);
11197     CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false;
11198   }
11199 
11200   // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
11201   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
11202   if (ExplicitSignature) {
11203     for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) {
11204       ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I);
11205       if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
11206           !Param->isImplicit() &&
11207           !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
11208           !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
11209         Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
11210       Params.push_back(Param);
11211     }
11212 
11213   // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
11214   //   ^ fntype { ... }
11215   } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
11216     for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) {
11217       ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(
11218           CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getLocStart(), I);
11219       Params.push_back(Param);
11220     }
11221   }
11222 
11223   // Set the parameters on the block decl.
11224   if (!Params.empty()) {
11225     CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params);
11226     CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
11227                              CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
11228                              /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
11229   }
11230 
11231   // Finally we can process decl attributes.
11232   ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
11233 
11234   // Put the parameter variables in scope.
11235   for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->params()) {
11236     AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
11237 
11238     // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
11239     if (AI->getIdentifier()) {
11240       CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI);
11241 
11242       PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
11243     }
11244   }
11245 }
11246 
11247 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
11248 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
11249 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
11250   // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
11251   DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
11252   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
11253 
11254   // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
11255   PopDeclContext();
11256   PopFunctionScopeInfo();
11257 }
11258 
11259 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
11260 /// literal was successfully completed.  ^(int x){...}
11261 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
11262                                     Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
11263   // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
11264   if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
11265     Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
11266 
11267   // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
11268   if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
11269     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
11270   assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within block not correctly bound!");
11271   PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
11272 
11273   BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
11274 
11275   if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType)
11276     deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI);
11277 
11278   PopDeclContext();
11279 
11280   QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
11281   if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
11282     RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
11283 
11284   bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
11285   QualType BlockTy;
11286 
11287   // Set the captured variables on the block.
11288   // FIXME: Share capture structure between BlockDecl and CapturingScopeInfo!
11289   SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures;
11290   for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Captures.size(); i != e; i++) {
11291     CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = BSI->Captures[i];
11292     if (Cap.isThisCapture())
11293       continue;
11294     BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Cap.getVariable(), Cap.isBlockCapture(),
11295                               Cap.isNested(), Cap.getInitExpr());
11296     Captures.push_back(NewCap);
11297   }
11298   BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, Captures.begin(), Captures.end(),
11299                             BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0);
11300 
11301   // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
11302   if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
11303     const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
11304 
11305     FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
11306     if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
11307 
11308     // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
11309     if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
11310       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
11311       EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
11312       BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
11313 
11314     // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
11315     // preserve its sugar structure.
11316     } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy &&
11317                (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
11318       BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
11319 
11320     // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
11321     } else {
11322       const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
11323       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
11324       EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently?
11325       EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
11326       BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
11327     }
11328 
11329   // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
11330   } else {
11331     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
11332     EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn);
11333     BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
11334   }
11335 
11336   DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
11337                            BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
11338   BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
11339 
11340   // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
11341   if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() &&
11342       !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
11343     DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
11344 
11345   BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
11346 
11347   // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again
11348   // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around
11349   // to deduce an implicit return type.
11350   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() &&
11351       !BSI->TheDecl->isDependentContext())
11352     computeNRVO(Body, BSI);
11353 
11354   BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
11355   AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
11356   PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result);
11357 
11358   // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at
11359   // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context:
11360   if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) {
11361     // First, this expression has a new cleanup object.
11362     ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl());
11363     ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
11364 
11365     // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured
11366     // variables needs destruction.
11367     for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) {
11368       const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable();
11369       if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) {
11370         getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope();
11371         break;
11372       }
11373     }
11374   }
11375 
11376   return Result;
11377 }
11378 
11379 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11380                                         Expr *E, ParsedType Ty,
11381                                         SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11382   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
11383   GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
11384   return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc);
11385 }
11386 
11387 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11388                                 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
11389                                 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11390   Expr *OrigExpr = E;
11391 
11392   // Get the va_list type
11393   QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
11394   if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
11395     // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
11396     // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
11397     // a pointer for va_arg.
11398     VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
11399     // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
11400     ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
11401     if (Result.isInvalid())
11402       return ExprError();
11403     E = Result.get();
11404   } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11405     // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode,
11406     // check the argument using reference binding.
11407     InitializedEntity Entity
11408       = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11409           Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false);
11410     ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E);
11411     if (Init.isInvalid())
11412       return ExprError();
11413     E = Init.getAs<Expr>();
11414   } else {
11415     // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
11416     // it is modified by va_arg.
11417     if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
11418         CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
11419       return ExprError();
11420   }
11421 
11422   if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
11423       !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
11424     return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
11425                          diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
11426       << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
11427   }
11428 
11429   if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) {
11430     if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(),
11431                             diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete,
11432                             TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
11433       return ExprError();
11434 
11435     if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
11436                                TInfo->getType(),
11437                                diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract,
11438                                TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
11439       return ExprError();
11440 
11441     if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) {
11442       Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
11443            TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType()
11444              ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified
11445              : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod)
11446         << TInfo->getType()
11447         << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
11448     }
11449 
11450     // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted
11451     // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior).
11452     QualType PromoteType;
11453     if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
11454       PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType());
11455       if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType()))
11456         PromoteType = QualType();
11457     }
11458     if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
11459       PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy;
11460     if (!PromoteType.isNull())
11461       DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E,
11462                   PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible)
11463                           << TInfo->getType()
11464                           << PromoteType
11465                           << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange());
11466   }
11467 
11468   QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11469   return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T);
11470 }
11471 
11472 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
11473   // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
11474   // pointers on the target.
11475   QualType Ty;
11476   unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0);
11477   if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth())
11478     Ty = Context.IntTy;
11479   else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())
11480     Ty = Context.LongTy;
11481   else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth())
11482     Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
11483   else {
11484     llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!");
11485   }
11486 
11487   return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc);
11488 }
11489 
11490 bool
11491 Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp) {
11492   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
11493     return false;
11494 
11495   const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11496   if (!PT)
11497     return false;
11498 
11499   if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
11500     // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
11501     const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
11502     if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
11503       return false;
11504   }
11505 
11506   // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be
11507   // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values.  The last is
11508   // important for making this trigger for property assignments.
11509   Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11510   if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr))
11511     if (OV->getSourceExpr())
11512       SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11513 
11514   StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr);
11515   if (!SL || !SL->isAscii())
11516     return false;
11517   Diag(SL->getLocStart(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix)
11518     << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
11519   Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getLocStart(), SL).get();
11520   return true;
11521 }
11522 
11523 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
11524                                     SourceLocation Loc,
11525                                     QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
11526                                     Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
11527                                     bool *Complained) {
11528   if (Complained)
11529     *Complained = false;
11530 
11531   // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
11532   bool CheckInferredResultType = false;
11533   bool isInvalid = false;
11534   unsigned DiagKind = 0;
11535   FixItHint Hint;
11536   ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints;
11537   bool MayHaveConvFixit = false;
11538   bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false;
11539   const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
11540   const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr;
11541 
11542   switch (ConvTy) {
11543   case Compatible:
11544       DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr);
11545       return false;
11546 
11547   case PointerToInt:
11548     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
11549     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11550     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11551     break;
11552   case IntToPointer:
11553     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
11554     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11555     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11556     break;
11557   case IncompatiblePointer:
11558       DiagKind =
11559         (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited ?
11560           diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer :
11561           diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer);
11562     CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
11563       SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType();
11564     if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) {
11565       ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11566     }
11567     else if (CheckInferredResultType) {
11568       SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType();
11569       DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType();
11570     }
11571     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11572     break;
11573   case IncompatiblePointerSign:
11574     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
11575     break;
11576   case FunctionVoidPointer:
11577     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
11578     break;
11579   case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: {
11580     // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary.
11581     if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType);
11582 
11583     Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
11584     Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
11585     if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) {
11586       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space;
11587       break;
11588 
11589 
11590     } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) {
11591       DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership;
11592       break;
11593     }
11594 
11595     llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!");
11596     // fallthrough
11597   }
11598   case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
11599     // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
11600     // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
11601     // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2).  FIXME:
11602     // Ideally, this check would be performed in
11603     // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
11604     // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
11605     // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
11606     // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for
11607     // C++ semantics.
11608     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
11609         IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
11610       return false;
11611     DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
11612     break;
11613   case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
11614     DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
11615     break;
11616   case IntToBlockPointer:
11617     DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
11618     break;
11619   case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
11620     DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
11621     break;
11622   case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: {
11623     if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
11624       const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT =
11625                 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11626       for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) {
11627         PDecl = srcProto;
11628         break;
11629       }
11630       if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
11631             DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
11632         IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
11633     }
11634     else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
11635       const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT =
11636         DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11637       for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) {
11638         PDecl = dstProto;
11639         break;
11640       }
11641       if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
11642             SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
11643         IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
11644     }
11645     DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
11646     break;
11647   }
11648   case IncompatibleVectors:
11649     DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
11650     break;
11651   case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef:
11652     DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign;
11653     break;
11654   case Incompatible:
11655     DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
11656     ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11657     MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11658     isInvalid = true;
11659     MayHaveFunctionDiff = true;
11660     break;
11661   }
11662 
11663   QualType FirstType, SecondType;
11664   switch (Action) {
11665   case AA_Assigning:
11666   case AA_Initializing:
11667     // The destination type comes first.
11668     FirstType = DstType;
11669     SecondType = SrcType;
11670     break;
11671 
11672   case AA_Returning:
11673   case AA_Passing:
11674   case AA_Passing_CFAudited:
11675   case AA_Converting:
11676   case AA_Sending:
11677   case AA_Casting:
11678     // The source type comes first.
11679     FirstType = SrcType;
11680     SecondType = DstType;
11681     break;
11682   }
11683 
11684   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind);
11685   if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited)
11686     FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
11687   else
11688     FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
11689 
11690   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
11691   assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull());
11692   if (!ConvHints.isNull()) {
11693     for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = ConvHints.Hints.begin(),
11694          HE = ConvHints.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
11695       FDiag << *HI;
11696   } else {
11697     FDiag << Hint;
11698   }
11699   if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); }
11700 
11701   if (MayHaveFunctionDiff)
11702     HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType);
11703 
11704   Diag(Loc, FDiag);
11705   if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id &&
11706       PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition())
11707       Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::not_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id)
11708         << IFace->getName() << PDecl->getName();
11709 
11710   if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy)
11711     NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression,
11712                               FirstType);
11713 
11714   if (CheckInferredResultType)
11715     EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr);
11716 
11717   if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer)
11718     EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType);
11719 
11720   if (Complained)
11721     *Complained = true;
11722   return isInvalid;
11723 }
11724 
11725 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
11726                                                  llvm::APSInt *Result) {
11727   class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
11728   public:
11729     void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
11730       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR;
11731     }
11732   } Diagnoser;
11733 
11734   return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser);
11735 }
11736 
11737 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
11738                                                  llvm::APSInt *Result,
11739                                                  unsigned DiagID,
11740                                                  bool AllowFold) {
11741   class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
11742     unsigned DiagID;
11743 
11744   public:
11745     IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID)
11746       : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { }
11747 
11748     void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
11749       S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR;
11750     }
11751   } Diagnoser(DiagID);
11752 
11753   return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold);
11754 }
11755 
11756 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11757                                             SourceRange SR) {
11758   S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus;
11759 }
11760 
11761 ExprResult
11762 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result,
11763                                       VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
11764                                       bool AllowFold) {
11765   SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getLocStart();
11766 
11767   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
11768     // C++11 [expr.const]p5:
11769     //   If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an
11770     //   integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall
11771     //   have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or
11772     //   unscoped enumeration type
11773     ExprResult Converted;
11774     class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser {
11775     public:
11776       CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent)
11777           : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false,
11778                                 Silent, true) {}
11779 
11780       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11781                                            QualType T) override {
11782         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T;
11783       }
11784 
11785       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete(
11786           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
11787         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T;
11788       }
11789 
11790       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv(
11791           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
11792         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy;
11793       }
11794 
11795       SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv(
11796           Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
11797         return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
11798                  << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
11799       }
11800 
11801       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous(
11802           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
11803         return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T;
11804       }
11805 
11806       SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous(
11807           Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
11808         return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
11809                  << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
11810       }
11811 
11812       SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion(
11813           Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
11814         llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted");
11815       }
11816     } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress);
11817 
11818     Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E,
11819                                                     ConvertDiagnoser);
11820     if (Converted.isInvalid())
11821       return Converted;
11822     E = Converted.get();
11823     if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
11824       return ExprError();
11825   } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
11826     // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type.
11827     if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
11828       Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11829     return ExprError();
11830   }
11831 
11832   // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice
11833   // in the non-ICE case.
11834   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) {
11835     if (Result)
11836       *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstInt(Context);
11837     return E;
11838   }
11839 
11840   Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
11841   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
11842   EvalResult.Diag = &Notes;
11843 
11844   // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's
11845   // not a constant expression as a side-effect.
11846   bool Folded = E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context) &&
11847                 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects;
11848 
11849   // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression
11850   // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then
11851   // this is a constant expression.
11852   if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) {
11853     if (Result)
11854       *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
11855     return E;
11856   }
11857 
11858   // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point
11859   // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially
11860   // redundant note.
11861   if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
11862         diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
11863     DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
11864     Notes.clear();
11865   }
11866 
11867   if (!Folded || !AllowFold) {
11868     if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) {
11869       Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11870       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
11871         Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
11872     }
11873 
11874     return ExprError();
11875   }
11876 
11877   Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11878   for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
11879     Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
11880 
11881   if (Result)
11882     *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
11883   return E;
11884 }
11885 
11886 namespace {
11887   // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively
11888   // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated.
11889   class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> {
11890     typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform;
11891 
11892   public:
11893     TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { }
11894 
11895     // Make sure we redo semantic analysis
11896     bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; }
11897 
11898     // Make sure we handle LabelStmts correctly.
11899     // FIXME: This does the right thing, but maybe we need a more general
11900     // fix to TreeTransform?
11901     StmtResult TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt *S) {
11902       S->getDecl()->setStmt(nullptr);
11903       return BaseTransform::TransformLabelStmt(S);
11904     }
11905 
11906     // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which
11907     // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming
11908     // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST.
11909     // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this
11910     // case?
11911     //
11912     // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls.
11913     ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
11914       if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) &&
11915           !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
11916         return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(),
11917                             diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
11918             << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
11919 
11920       return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E);
11921     }
11922 
11923     // Exception: filter out member pointer formation
11924     ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
11925       if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType())
11926         return E;
11927 
11928       return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E);
11929     }
11930 
11931     ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) {
11932       // Lambdas never need to be transformed.
11933       return E;
11934     }
11935   };
11936 }
11937 
11938 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) {
11939   assert(isUnevaluatedContext() &&
11940          "Should only transform unevaluated expressions");
11941   ExprEvalContexts.back().Context =
11942       ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context;
11943   if (isUnevaluatedContext())
11944     return E;
11945   return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E);
11946 }
11947 
11948 void
11949 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,
11950                                       Decl *LambdaContextDecl,
11951                                       bool IsDecltype) {
11952   ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(),
11953                                 ExprNeedsCleanups, LambdaContextDecl,
11954                                 IsDecltype);
11955   ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
11956   if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty())
11957     std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
11958 }
11959 
11960 void
11961 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,
11962                                       ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,
11963                                       bool IsDecltype) {
11964   Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl;
11965   PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, IsDecltype);
11966 }
11967 
11968 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
11969   ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
11970   unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos;
11971 
11972   if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) {
11973     if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) {
11974       unsigned D;
11975       if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) {
11976         // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2:
11977         //   A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand
11978         //   (Clause 5).
11979         D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand;
11980       } else {
11981         // C++1y [expr.const]p2:
11982         //   A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the
11983         //   evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would
11984         //   evaluate [...] a lambda-expression.
11985         D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression;
11986       }
11987       for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas)
11988         Diag(L->getLocStart(), D);
11989     } else {
11990       // Mark the capture expressions odr-used. This was deferred
11991       // during lambda expression creation.
11992       for (auto *Lambda : Rec.Lambdas) {
11993         for (auto *C : Lambda->capture_inits())
11994           MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(C);
11995       }
11996     }
11997   }
11998 
11999   // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
12000   // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
12001   // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
12002   // will never be constructed.
12003   if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) {
12004     ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects,
12005                              ExprCleanupObjects.end());
12006     ExprNeedsCleanups = Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
12007     CleanupVarDeclMarking();
12008     std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
12009   // Otherwise, merge the contexts together.
12010   } else {
12011     ExprNeedsCleanups |= Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
12012     MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(),
12013                             Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end());
12014   }
12015 
12016   // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
12017   ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
12018 
12019   if (!ExprEvalContexts.empty())
12020     ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos;
12021   else
12022     assert(NumTypos == 0 && "There are outstanding typos after popping the "
12023                             "last ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord");
12024 }
12025 
12026 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() {
12027   ExprCleanupObjects.erase(
12028          ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects,
12029          ExprCleanupObjects.end());
12030   ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
12031   MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
12032 }
12033 
12034 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) {
12035   if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
12036     return E;
12037   return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
12038 }
12039 
12040 static bool IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) {
12041   // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
12042   // an instantiation.
12043   if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext())
12044     return false;
12045 
12046   switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
12047     case Sema::Unevaluated:
12048     case Sema::UnevaluatedAbstract:
12049       // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
12050       // (Depending on how you read the standard, we actually do need to do
12051       // something here for null pointer constants, but the standard's
12052       // definition of a null pointer constant is completely crazy.)
12053       return false;
12054 
12055     case Sema::ConstantEvaluated:
12056     case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated:
12057       // We are in a potentially evaluated expression (or a constant-expression
12058       // in C++03); we need to do implicit template instantiation, implicitly
12059       // define class members, and mark most declarations as used.
12060       return true;
12061 
12062     case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
12063       // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
12064       // containing expression is used.
12065       return false;
12066   }
12067   llvm_unreachable("Invalid context");
12068 }
12069 
12070 /// \brief Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
12071 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3)
12072 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func,
12073                                   bool OdrUse) {
12074   assert(Func && "No function?");
12075 
12076   Func->setReferenced();
12077 
12078   // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3:
12079   //   A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is
12080   //   odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a
12081   //   set of overloaded functions [...].
12082   //
12083   // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we
12084   // can just check that here. Skip the rest of this function if we've already
12085   // marked the function as used.
12086   if (Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false) ||
12087       !IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(*this)) {
12088     // C++11 [temp.inst]p3:
12089     //   Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly
12090     //   instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template
12091     //   specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is
12092     //   referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist.
12093     //
12094     // We consider constexpr function templates to be referenced in a context
12095     // that requires a definition to exist whenever they are referenced.
12096     //
12097     // FIXME: This instantiates constexpr functions too frequently. If this is
12098     // really an unevaluated context (and we're not just in the definition of a
12099     // function template or overload resolution or other cases which we
12100     // incorrectly consider to be unevaluated contexts), and we're not in a
12101     // subexpression which we actually need to evaluate (for instance, a
12102     // template argument, array bound or an expression in a braced-init-list),
12103     // we are not permitted to instantiate this constexpr function definition.
12104     //
12105     // FIXME: This also implicitly defines special members too frequently. They
12106     // are only supposed to be implicitly defined if they are odr-used, but they
12107     // are not odr-used from constant expressions in unevaluated contexts.
12108     // However, they cannot be referenced if they are deleted, and they are
12109     // deleted whenever the implicit definition of the special member would
12110     // fail.
12111     if (!Func->isConstexpr() || Func->getBody())
12112       return;
12113     CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func);
12114     if (!Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() && (!MD || MD->isUserProvided()))
12115       return;
12116   }
12117 
12118   // Note that this declaration has been used.
12119   if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
12120     Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl());
12121     if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) {
12122       if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
12123         if (Constructor->isTrivial() && !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
12124           return;
12125         DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12126       } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) {
12127         DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12128       } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) {
12129         DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12130       }
12131     } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) {
12132       DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12133     }
12134   } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
12135                  dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) {
12136     Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl());
12137     if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) {
12138       if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
12139         return;
12140       DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
12141     }
12142     if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
12143       MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
12144   } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) {
12145     if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
12146         MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
12147       MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
12148       if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) {
12149         if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
12150           DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
12151         else
12152           DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
12153       }
12154     } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) &&
12155                MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) {
12156       CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
12157           cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
12158       if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion())
12159         DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
12160       else
12161         DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
12162     } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
12163       MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
12164   }
12165 
12166   // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
12167   // FIXME: Is this really right?
12168   if (CurContext == Func) return;
12169 
12170   // Resolve the exception specification for any function which is
12171   // used: CodeGen will need it.
12172   const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
12173   if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()))
12174     ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
12175 
12176   if (!OdrUse) return;
12177 
12178   // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
12179   // class templates.
12180   if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
12181     bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
12182     SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
12183     if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
12184                               = Func->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
12185       if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
12186         SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
12187       else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
12188                  == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
12189         AlreadyInstantiated = true;
12190         PointOfInstantiation = SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation();
12191       }
12192     } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
12193                                 = Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
12194       if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
12195         MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
12196       else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
12197                  == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
12198         AlreadyInstantiated = true;
12199         PointOfInstantiation = MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation();
12200       }
12201     }
12202 
12203     if (!AlreadyInstantiated || Func->isConstexpr()) {
12204       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) &&
12205           cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() &&
12206           ActiveTemplateInstantiations.size())
12207         PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(
12208             std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation));
12209       else if (Func->isConstexpr())
12210         // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the
12211         // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a
12212         // call to such a function.
12213         InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func);
12214       else {
12215         PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Func,
12216                                                        PointOfInstantiation));
12217         // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated.
12218         Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func);
12219       }
12220     }
12221   } else {
12222     // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
12223     for (auto i : Func->redecls()) {
12224       if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
12225         MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i);
12226     }
12227   }
12228 
12229   // Keep track of used but undefined functions.
12230   if (!Func->isDefined()) {
12231     if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func))
12232       UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
12233     else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() &&
12234              (LangOpts.CPlusPlus || !LangOpts.GNUInline) &&
12235              !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
12236       UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
12237   }
12238 
12239   // Normally the most current decl is marked used while processing the use and
12240   // any subsequent decls are marked used by decl merging. This fails with
12241   // template instantiation since marking can happen at the end of the file
12242   // and, because of the two phase lookup, this function is called with at
12243   // decl in the middle of a decl chain. We loop to maintain the invariant
12244   // that once a decl is used, all decls after it are also used.
12245   for (FunctionDecl *F = Func->getMostRecentDecl();; F = F->getPreviousDecl()) {
12246     F->markUsed(Context);
12247     if (F == Func)
12248       break;
12249   }
12250 }
12251 
12252 static void
12253 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
12254                                    VarDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) {
12255   DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext();
12256 
12257   //  If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then
12258   //  we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of
12259   //  the next.
12260   if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) &&
12261       isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC))
12262     return;
12263 
12264   // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code
12265   // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of
12266   // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later.
12267   //
12268   // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this
12269   // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound
12270   // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious.
12271   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
12272     return;
12273 
12274   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) &&
12275       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) {
12276     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_lambda)
12277       << var->getIdentifier();
12278   } else if (FunctionDecl *fn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) {
12279     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
12280       << var->getIdentifier() << fn->getDeclName();
12281   } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) {
12282     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_block)
12283       << var->getIdentifier();
12284   } else {
12285     // FIXME: Is there any other context where a local variable can be
12286     // declared?
12287     S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_context)
12288       << var->getIdentifier();
12289   }
12290 
12291   S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
12292       << var->getIdentifier();
12293 
12294   // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents
12295   // capture.
12296 }
12297 
12298 
12299 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
12300                                       bool &SubCapturesAreNested,
12301                                       QualType &CaptureType,
12302                                       QualType &DeclRefType) {
12303    // Check whether we've already captured it.
12304   if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) {
12305     // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested.
12306     SubCapturesAreNested = true;
12307 
12308     // Retrieve the capture type for this variable.
12309     CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType();
12310 
12311     // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable.
12312     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12313 
12314     const CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var);
12315     if (Cap.isCopyCapture() &&
12316         !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable))
12317       DeclRefType.addConst();
12318     return true;
12319   }
12320   return false;
12321 }
12322 
12323 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
12324 // capture; other scopes don't work.
12325 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var,
12326                                  SourceLocation Loc,
12327                                  const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
12328   if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC))
12329     return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
12330   else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) {
12331     if (Diagnose)
12332        diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC);
12333   }
12334   return nullptr;
12335 }
12336 
12337 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
12338 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
12339 // so check for eligibility.
12340 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
12341                                  SourceLocation Loc,
12342                                  const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
12343 
12344   bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI);
12345   bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12346 
12347   // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables
12348   // (e.g. anonymous unions).
12349   // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm
12350   // assuming that's the intent.
12351   if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) {
12352     if (Diagnose) {
12353       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var);
12354       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
12355     }
12356     return false;
12357   }
12358 
12359   // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with.
12360   if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) {
12361     if (Diagnose) {
12362       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
12363       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12364         << Var->getDeclName();
12365     }
12366     return false;
12367   }
12368   // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too.
12369   // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct.
12370   if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
12371     if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
12372       if (Diagnose) {
12373         if (IsBlock)
12374           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type);
12375         else
12376           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type)
12377             << Var->getDeclName();
12378         S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12379           << Var->getDeclName();
12380       }
12381       return false;
12382     }
12383   }
12384   const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
12385   // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block
12386   // variables; they don't support the expected semantics.
12387   if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) {
12388     if (Diagnose) {
12389       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable)
12390         << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda;
12391       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12392         << Var->getDeclName();
12393     }
12394     return false;
12395   }
12396 
12397   return true;
12398 }
12399 
12400 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful.
12401 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var,
12402                                  SourceLocation Loc,
12403                                  const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12404                                  QualType &CaptureType,
12405                                  QualType &DeclRefType,
12406                                  const bool Nested,
12407                                  Sema &S) {
12408   Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
12409   bool ByRef = false;
12410 
12411   // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays.
12412   if (CaptureType->isArrayType()) {
12413     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12414       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
12415       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12416       << Var->getDeclName();
12417     }
12418     return false;
12419   }
12420 
12421   // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables.
12422   if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
12423     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12424       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture)
12425         << /*block*/ 0;
12426       S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12427         << Var->getDeclName();
12428     }
12429     return false;
12430   }
12431   const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
12432   if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType()) {
12433     // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or
12434     // declaration reference types.
12435     ByRef = true;
12436   } else {
12437     // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'.
12438     CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst();
12439     DeclRefType = CaptureType;
12440 
12441     if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuildAndDiagnose) {
12442       if (const RecordType *Record = DeclRefType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
12443         // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it.
12444         // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have
12445         // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are
12446         // an exception because it's technically only the call site that
12447         // actually requires the destructor.
12448         if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
12449           S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record);
12450 
12451         // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the copy
12452         // full-expression.
12453         EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, S.PotentiallyEvaluated);
12454 
12455         // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from
12456         // the stack requires a const copy constructor.  This is not true
12457         // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap.
12458         Expr *DeclRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, Nested,
12459                                                   DeclRefType.withConst(),
12460                                                   VK_LValue, Loc);
12461 
12462         ExprResult Result
12463           = S.PerformCopyInitialization(
12464               InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(),
12465                                                   CaptureType, false),
12466               Loc, DeclRef);
12467 
12468         // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization
12469         // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor.  Recover from
12470         // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary.
12471         if (!Result.isInvalid() &&
12472             !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor()
12473                 ->isTrivial()) {
12474           Result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result);
12475           CopyExpr = Result.get();
12476         }
12477       }
12478     }
12479   }
12480 
12481   // Actually capture the variable.
12482   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12483     BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc,
12484                     SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr);
12485 
12486   return true;
12487 
12488 }
12489 
12490 
12491 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the captured region.
12492 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI,
12493                                     VarDecl *Var,
12494                                     SourceLocation Loc,
12495                                     const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12496                                     QualType &CaptureType,
12497                                     QualType &DeclRefType,
12498                                     const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
12499                                     Sema &S) {
12500 
12501   // By default, capture variables by reference.
12502   bool ByRef = true;
12503   // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below).
12504   CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
12505   Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
12506   if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12507     // The current implementation assumes that all variables are captured
12508     // by references. Since there is no capture by copy, no expression
12509     // evaluation will be needed.
12510     RecordDecl *RD = RSI->TheRecordDecl;
12511 
12512     FieldDecl *Field
12513       = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, RD, Loc, Loc, nullptr, CaptureType,
12514                           S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CaptureType, Loc),
12515                           nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit);
12516     Field->setImplicit(true);
12517     Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12518     RD->addDecl(Field);
12519 
12520     CopyExpr = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable,
12521                                             DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc);
12522     Var->setReferenced(true);
12523     Var->markUsed(S.Context);
12524   }
12525 
12526   // Actually capture the variable.
12527   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12528     RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, Loc,
12529                     SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr);
12530 
12531 
12532   return true;
12533 }
12534 
12535 /// \brief Create a field within the lambda class for the variable
12536 /// being captured.
12537 static void addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema &S, LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, VarDecl *Var,
12538                                     QualType FieldType, QualType DeclRefType,
12539                                     SourceLocation Loc,
12540                                     bool RefersToCapturedVariable) {
12541   CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = LSI->Lambda;
12542 
12543   // Build the non-static data member.
12544   FieldDecl *Field
12545     = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, Lambda, Loc, Loc, nullptr, FieldType,
12546                         S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FieldType, Loc),
12547                         nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit);
12548   Field->setImplicit(true);
12549   Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12550   Lambda->addDecl(Field);
12551 }
12552 
12553 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the lambda.
12554 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
12555                             VarDecl *Var,
12556                             SourceLocation Loc,
12557                             const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12558                             QualType &CaptureType,
12559                             QualType &DeclRefType,
12560                             const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
12561                             const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind,
12562                             SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
12563                             const bool IsTopScope,
12564                             Sema &S) {
12565 
12566   // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value.
12567   bool ByRef = false;
12568   if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) {
12569     ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef);
12570   } else {
12571     ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref);
12572   }
12573 
12574   // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable.
12575   if (ByRef) {
12576     // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15:
12577     //   An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or
12578     //   explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is
12579     //   unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data
12580     //   members are declared in the closure type for entities
12581     //   captured by reference.
12582     //
12583     // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference
12584     // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears
12585     // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will
12586     // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and
12587     // easily defensible position.
12588     CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
12589   } else {
12590     // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14:
12591     //   For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static
12592     //   data member is declared in the closure type. The
12593     //   declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type
12594     //   of such a data member is the type of the corresponding
12595     //   captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an
12596     //   object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the
12597     //   captured entity is a reference to a function, the
12598     //   corresponding data member is also a reference to a
12599     //   function. - end note ]
12600     if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){
12601       if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
12602         CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType();
12603     }
12604 
12605     // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables.
12606     if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
12607       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12608         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1;
12609         S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12610           << Var->getDeclName();
12611       }
12612       return false;
12613     }
12614 
12615     // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type.
12616     if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12617       if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() &&
12618           S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType,
12619                                 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type,
12620                                 Var->getDeclName()))
12621         return false;
12622 
12623       if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType,
12624                                    diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type))
12625         return false;
12626     }
12627   }
12628 
12629   // Capture this variable in the lambda.
12630   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12631     addAsFieldToClosureType(S, LSI, Var, CaptureType, DeclRefType, Loc,
12632                             RefersToCapturedVariable);
12633 
12634   // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable.
12635   if (ByRef)
12636     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12637   else {
12638     // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5:
12639     //   The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline
12640     //   function call operator [...]. This function call operator is
12641     //   declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression’s
12642     //   parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable.
12643     DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12644     if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType())
12645       DeclRefType.addConst();
12646   }
12647 
12648   // Add the capture.
12649   if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12650     LSI->addCapture(Var, /*IsBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable,
12651                     Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, /*CopyExpr=*/nullptr);
12652 
12653   return true;
12654 }
12655 
12656 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(
12657     VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind,
12658     SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType,
12659     QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
12660   // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its
12661   // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class.
12662   DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext();
12663   if (Var->isInitCapture())
12664     VarDC = VarDC->getParent();
12665 
12666   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
12667   const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
12668       ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
12669   // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the
12670   // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
12671   if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
12672     unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
12673     while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) {
12674       DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
12675       --FSIndex;
12676     }
12677   }
12678 
12679 
12680   // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to
12681   // capture it.
12682   if (VarDC == DC) return true;
12683 
12684   // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this
12685   // variable.
12686   bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage();
12687   if (IsGlobal && !(LangOpts.OpenMP && IsOpenMPCapturedVar(Var)))
12688     return true;
12689 
12690   // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable,
12691   // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when
12692   // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing
12693   // capture of that variable.  We start from the innermost capturing-entity
12694   // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities
12695   // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s
12696   // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured
12697   // the variable.
12698   CaptureType = Var->getType();
12699   DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12700   bool Nested = false;
12701   bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit);
12702   unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex;
12703   do {
12704     // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
12705     // capture; other scopes don't work.
12706     DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var,
12707                                                               ExprLoc,
12708                                                               BuildAndDiagnose,
12709                                                               *this);
12710     // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have*
12711     // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in
12712     // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc.
12713     if (!ParentDC) {
12714       if (IsGlobal) {
12715         FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1;
12716         break;
12717       }
12718       return true;
12719     }
12720 
12721     FunctionScopeInfo  *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex];
12722     CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI);
12723 
12724 
12725     // Check whether we've already captured it.
12726     if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType,
12727                                              DeclRefType))
12728       break;
12729     // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body,
12730     // we do not want to capture new variables.  What was captured
12731     // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing
12732     // should be used.
12733     if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) {
12734       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12735         LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12736         if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) {
12737           Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
12738           Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12739              << Var->getDeclName();
12740           Diag(LSI->Lambda->getLocStart(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
12741         } else
12742           diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC);
12743       }
12744       return true;
12745     }
12746     // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
12747     // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
12748     // so check for eligibility.
12749     if (!isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this))
12750        return true;
12751 
12752     // Try to capture variable-length arrays types.
12753     if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
12754       // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA
12755       // expressions.
12756       QualType QTy = Var->getType();
12757       if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
12758         QTy = PVD->getOriginalType();
12759       do {
12760         const Type *Ty = QTy.getTypePtr();
12761         switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) {
12762 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
12763 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
12764 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
12765 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
12766 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)
12767 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
12768           QTy = QualType();
12769           break;
12770         // These types are never variably-modified.
12771         case Type::Builtin:
12772         case Type::Complex:
12773         case Type::Vector:
12774         case Type::ExtVector:
12775         case Type::Record:
12776         case Type::Enum:
12777         case Type::Elaborated:
12778         case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
12779         case Type::ObjCObject:
12780         case Type::ObjCInterface:
12781         case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
12782           llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!");
12783         case Type::Adjusted:
12784           QTy = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType();
12785           break;
12786         case Type::Decayed:
12787           QTy = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12788           break;
12789         case Type::Pointer:
12790           QTy = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12791           break;
12792         case Type::BlockPointer:
12793           QTy = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12794           break;
12795         case Type::LValueReference:
12796         case Type::RValueReference:
12797           QTy = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12798           break;
12799         case Type::MemberPointer:
12800           QTy = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12801           break;
12802         case Type::ConstantArray:
12803         case Type::IncompleteArray:
12804           // Losing element qualification here is fine.
12805           QTy = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType();
12806           break;
12807         case Type::VariableArray: {
12808           // Losing element qualification here is fine.
12809           const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty);
12810 
12811           // Unknown size indication requires no size computation.
12812           // Otherwise, evaluate and record it.
12813           if (auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr()) {
12814             if (!CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT)) {
12815               RecordDecl *CapRecord = nullptr;
12816               if (auto LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12817                 CapRecord = LSI->Lambda;
12818               } else if (auto CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12819                 CapRecord = CRSI->TheRecordDecl;
12820               }
12821               if (CapRecord) {
12822                 auto ExprLoc = Size->getExprLoc();
12823                 auto SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
12824                 // Build the non-static data member.
12825                 auto Field = FieldDecl::Create(
12826                     Context, CapRecord, ExprLoc, ExprLoc,
12827                     /*Id*/ nullptr, SizeType, /*TInfo*/ nullptr,
12828                     /*BW*/ nullptr, /*Mutable*/ false,
12829                     /*InitStyle*/ ICIS_NoInit);
12830                 Field->setImplicit(true);
12831                 Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12832                 Field->setCapturedVLAType(VAT);
12833                 CapRecord->addDecl(Field);
12834 
12835                 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(ExprLoc, SizeType);
12836               }
12837             }
12838           }
12839           QTy = VAT->getElementType();
12840           break;
12841         }
12842         case Type::FunctionProto:
12843         case Type::FunctionNoProto:
12844           QTy = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType();
12845           break;
12846         case Type::Paren:
12847         case Type::TypeOf:
12848         case Type::UnaryTransform:
12849         case Type::Attributed:
12850         case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
12851         case Type::PackExpansion:
12852           // Keep walking after single level desugaring.
12853           QTy = QTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(getASTContext());
12854           break;
12855         case Type::Typedef:
12856           QTy = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar();
12857           break;
12858         case Type::Decltype:
12859           QTy = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar();
12860           break;
12861         case Type::Auto:
12862           QTy = cast<AutoType>(Ty)->getDeducedType();
12863           break;
12864         case Type::TypeOfExpr:
12865           QTy = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType();
12866           break;
12867         case Type::Atomic:
12868           QTy = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType();
12869           break;
12870         }
12871       } while (!QTy.isNull() && QTy->isVariablyModifiedType());
12872     }
12873 
12874     if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) {
12875       // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture
12876       // so cannot capture this variable.
12877       if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12878         Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
12879         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12880           << Var->getDeclName();
12881         Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getLocStart(),
12882              diag::note_lambda_decl);
12883         // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly
12884         // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we
12885         // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because
12886         // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later.  This would purely be done
12887         // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable
12888         // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured
12889         // explicitly.  Suggestion:
12890         //  - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit
12891         //    at the function head
12892         //  - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda
12893         //  - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable.
12894       }
12895       return true;
12896     }
12897 
12898     FunctionScopesIndex--;
12899     DC = ParentDC;
12900     Explicit = false;
12901   } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC));
12902 
12903   // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda)
12904   // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific
12905   // requirements, and adding captures if requested.
12906   // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing
12907   // at the lambda nested within that one.
12908   for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N;
12909        ++I) {
12910     CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]);
12911 
12912     if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12913       if (!captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc,
12914                           BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
12915                           DeclRefType, Nested, *this))
12916         return true;
12917       Nested = true;
12918     } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12919       if (!captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc,
12920                                    BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
12921                                    DeclRefType, Nested, *this))
12922         return true;
12923       Nested = true;
12924     } else {
12925       LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12926       if (!captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc,
12927                            BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
12928                            DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
12929                             /*IsTopScope*/I == N - 1, *this))
12930         return true;
12931       Nested = true;
12932     }
12933   }
12934   return false;
12935 }
12936 
12937 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc,
12938                               TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) {
12939   QualType CaptureType;
12940   QualType DeclRefType;
12941   return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
12942                             /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType,
12943                             DeclRefType, nullptr);
12944 }
12945 
12946 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
12947   QualType CaptureType;
12948   QualType DeclRefType;
12949   return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
12950                              /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
12951                              DeclRefType, nullptr);
12952 }
12953 
12954 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
12955   QualType CaptureType;
12956   QualType DeclRefType;
12957 
12958   // Determine whether we can capture this variable.
12959   if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
12960                          /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
12961                          DeclRefType, nullptr))
12962     return QualType();
12963 
12964   return DeclRefType;
12965 }
12966 
12967 
12968 
12969 // If either the type of the variable or the initializer is dependent,
12970 // return false. Otherwise, determine whether the variable is a constant
12971 // expression. Use this if you need to know if a variable that might or
12972 // might not be dependent is truly a constant expression.
12973 static inline bool IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl *Var,
12974     ASTContext &Context) {
12975 
12976   if (Var->getType()->isDependentType())
12977     return false;
12978   const VarDecl *DefVD = nullptr;
12979   Var->getAnyInitializer(DefVD);
12980   if (!DefVD)
12981     return false;
12982   EvaluatedStmt *Eval = DefVD->ensureEvaluatedStmt();
12983   Expr *Init = cast<Expr>(Eval->Value);
12984   if (Init->isValueDependent())
12985     return false;
12986   return IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, Context);
12987 }
12988 
12989 
12990 void Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr *E) {
12991   // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is
12992   // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a
12993   // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
12994   // is immediately applied."  This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue
12995   // conversion part.
12996   MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E->IgnoreParens());
12997 
12998   // If we are in a lambda, check if this DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr refers
12999   // to a variable that is a constant expression, and if so, identify it as
13000   // a reference to a variable that does not involve an odr-use of that
13001   // variable.
13002   if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) {
13003     Expr *SansParensExpr = E->IgnoreParens();
13004     VarDecl *Var = nullptr;
13005     if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SansParensExpr))
13006       Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getFoundDecl());
13007     else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(SansParensExpr))
13008       Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
13009 
13010     if (Var && IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, Context))
13011       LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(SansParensExpr);
13012   }
13013 }
13014 
13015 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) {
13016   Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res);
13017 
13018   if (!Res.isUsable())
13019     return Res;
13020 
13021   // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay
13022   // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the
13023   // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion.  In the one case where this doesn't happen
13024   // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway.
13025   UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Res.get());
13026   return Res;
13027 }
13028 
13029 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() {
13030   for (llvm::SmallPtrSetIterator<Expr*> i = MaybeODRUseExprs.begin(),
13031                                         e = MaybeODRUseExprs.end();
13032        i != e; ++i) {
13033     VarDecl *Var;
13034     SourceLocation Loc;
13035     if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(*i)) {
13036       Var = cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13037       Loc = DRE->getLocation();
13038     } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(*i)) {
13039       Var = cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
13040       Loc = ME->getMemberLoc();
13041     } else {
13042       llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression");
13043     }
13044 
13045     MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, *this,
13046                        /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex Pointer*/ nullptr);
13047   }
13048 
13049   MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
13050 }
13051 
13052 
13053 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
13054                                     VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) {
13055   assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E)) &&
13056          "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced");
13057   Var->setReferenced();
13058 
13059   TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind();
13060   bool MarkODRUsed = true;
13061 
13062   // If the context is not potentially evaluated, this is not an odr-use and
13063   // does not trigger instantiation.
13064   if (!IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(SemaRef)) {
13065     if (SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
13066       return;
13067 
13068     // If we don't yet know whether this context is going to end up being an
13069     // evaluated context, and we're referencing a variable from an enclosing
13070     // scope, add a potential capture.
13071     //
13072     // FIXME: Is this necessary? These contexts are only used for default
13073     // arguments, where local variables can't be used.
13074     const bool RefersToEnclosingScope =
13075         (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() &&
13076          Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage());
13077     if (RefersToEnclosingScope) {
13078       if (LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = SemaRef.getCurLambda()) {
13079         // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so
13080         // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any
13081         // lvalue-to-rvalue
13082         // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use.
13083         // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed
13084         // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking
13085         // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant
13086         // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used).
13087         assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression.");
13088         if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() ||
13089             !IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context))
13090           LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens());
13091       }
13092     }
13093 
13094     if (!isTemplateInstantiation(TSK))
13095     	return;
13096 
13097     // Instantiate, but do not mark as odr-used, variable templates.
13098     MarkODRUsed = false;
13099   }
13100 
13101   VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec =
13102       dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var);
13103   assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) &&
13104          "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization.");
13105 
13106   // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member
13107   // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay
13108   // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used
13109   // in a constant expression.
13110   if (isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) {
13111     bool TryInstantiating = TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation;
13112 
13113     if (TryInstantiating && !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) {
13114       if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) {
13115         // This is a modification of an existing AST node. Notify listeners.
13116         if (ASTMutationListener *L = SemaRef.getASTMutationListener())
13117           L->StaticDataMemberInstantiated(Var);
13118       } else if (!Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context))
13119         // Don't bother trying to instantiate it again, unless we might need
13120         // its initializer before we get to the end of the TU.
13121         TryInstantiating = false;
13122     }
13123 
13124     if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
13125       Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, Loc);
13126 
13127     if (TryInstantiating) {
13128       SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Var->getPointOfInstantiation();
13129       bool InstantiationDependent = false;
13130       bool IsNonDependent =
13131           VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments(
13132                         VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent)
13133                   : true;
13134 
13135       // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent.
13136       if (IsNonDependent) {
13137         if (Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) {
13138           // Do not defer instantiations of variables which could be used in a
13139           // constant expression.
13140           SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var);
13141         } else {
13142           SemaRef.PendingInstantiations
13143               .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation));
13144         }
13145       }
13146     }
13147   }
13148 
13149   if(!MarkODRUsed) return;
13150 
13151   // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it satisfies
13152   // the requirements for appearing in a constant expression (5.19) and, if
13153   // it is an object, the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
13154   // is immediately applied."  We check the first part here, and
13155   // Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue deals with the second part.
13156   // Note that we use the C++11 definition everywhere because nothing in
13157   // C++03 depends on whether we get the C++03 version correct. The second
13158   // part does not apply to references, since they are not objects.
13159   if (E && IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) {
13160     // A reference initialized by a constant expression can never be
13161     // odr-used, so simply ignore it.
13162     if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType())
13163       SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E);
13164   } else
13165     MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef,
13166                        /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex ptr*/ nullptr);
13167 }
13168 
13169 /// \brief Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
13170 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3).  Note that this should not be
13171 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl.
13172 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) {
13173   DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr);
13174 }
13175 
13176 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
13177                                Decl *D, Expr *E, bool OdrUse) {
13178   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
13179     DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E);
13180     return;
13181   }
13182 
13183   SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, OdrUse);
13184 
13185   // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the
13186   // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call.
13187   const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
13188   if (!ME)
13189     return;
13190   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
13191   if (!MD)
13192     return;
13193   // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call.
13194   bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && !ME->hasQualifier();
13195   if (!IsVirtualCall)
13196     return;
13197   const Expr *Base = ME->getBase();
13198   const CXXRecordDecl *MostDerivedClassDecl = Base->getBestDynamicClassType();
13199   if (!MostDerivedClassDecl)
13200     return;
13201   CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getCorrespondingMethodInClass(MostDerivedClassDecl);
13202   if (!DM || DM->isPure())
13203     return;
13204   SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, OdrUse);
13205 }
13206 
13207 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr.
13208 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13209   // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed.
13210   // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even
13211   // if it's a qualified reference.
13212   bool OdrUse = true;
13213   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl()))
13214     if (Method->isVirtual())
13215       OdrUse = false;
13216   MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse);
13217 }
13218 
13219 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr.
13220 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) {
13221   // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2:
13222   //   A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated
13223   //   expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by
13224   //   overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated
13225   //   expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its
13226   //   name is not explicitly qualified.
13227   bool OdrUse = true;
13228   if (!E->hasQualifier()) {
13229     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()))
13230       if (Method->isPure())
13231         OdrUse = false;
13232   }
13233   SourceLocation Loc = E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ?
13234                             E->getMemberLoc() : E->getLocStart();
13235   MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, OdrUse);
13236 }
13237 
13238 /// \brief Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration.  It
13239 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for
13240 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a
13241 /// normal expression which refers to a variable.
13242 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool OdrUse) {
13243   if (OdrUse) {
13244     if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
13245       MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD);
13246       return;
13247     }
13248   }
13249   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
13250     MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, OdrUse);
13251     return;
13252   }
13253   D->setReferenced();
13254 }
13255 
13256 namespace {
13257   // Mark all of the declarations referenced
13258   // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
13259   // of when we're entering
13260   class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
13261     Sema &S;
13262     SourceLocation Loc;
13263 
13264   public:
13265     typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
13266 
13267     MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
13268 
13269     bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
13270     bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
13271   };
13272 }
13273 
13274 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
13275     const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
13276   if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
13277     if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl())
13278       S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true);
13279   }
13280 
13281   return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
13282 }
13283 
13284 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
13285   if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
13286                   = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
13287     const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
13288     return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
13289   }
13290 
13291   return true;
13292 }
13293 
13294 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
13295   MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
13296   Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
13297 }
13298 
13299 namespace {
13300   /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
13301   /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
13302   class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
13303     Sema &S;
13304     bool SkipLocalVariables;
13305 
13306   public:
13307     typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
13308 
13309     EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables)
13310       : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { }
13311 
13312     void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13313       // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't.
13314       if (SkipLocalVariables) {
13315         if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl()))
13316           if (VD->hasLocalStorage())
13317             return;
13318       }
13319 
13320       S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
13321     }
13322 
13323     void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13324       S.MarkMemberReferenced(E);
13325       Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
13326     }
13327 
13328     void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) {
13329       S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
13330             const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor()));
13331       Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13332     }
13333 
13334     void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
13335       if (E->getOperatorNew())
13336         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
13337       if (E->getOperatorDelete())
13338         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
13339       Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
13340     }
13341 
13342     void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
13343       if (E->getOperatorDelete())
13344         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
13345       QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
13346       if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
13347         CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
13348         S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
13349                                     S.LookupDestructor(Record));
13350       }
13351 
13352       Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
13353     }
13354 
13355     void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
13356       S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
13357       Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
13358     }
13359 
13360     void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
13361       Visit(E->getExpr());
13362     }
13363 
13364     void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
13365       Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E);
13366 
13367       if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue)
13368         S.UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E->getSubExpr());
13369     }
13370   };
13371 }
13372 
13373 /// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
13374 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
13375 ///
13376 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as
13377 /// 'referenced'.
13378 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E,
13379                                             bool SkipLocalVariables) {
13380   EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E);
13381 }
13382 
13383 /// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
13384 /// of the program being compiled.
13385 ///
13386 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
13387 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
13388 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
13389 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
13390 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
13391 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
13392 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
13393 /// later.
13394 ///
13395 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
13396 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
13397 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
13398 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
13399 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement,
13400                                const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
13401   switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
13402   case Unevaluated:
13403   case UnevaluatedAbstract:
13404     // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
13405     break;
13406 
13407   case ConstantEvaluated:
13408     // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation.
13409     break;
13410 
13411   case PotentiallyEvaluated:
13412   case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
13413     if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) {
13414       FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags.
13415         push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement));
13416     }
13417     else
13418       Diag(Loc, PD);
13419 
13420     return true;
13421   }
13422 
13423   return false;
13424 }
13425 
13426 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
13427                                CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
13428   if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
13429     return false;
13430 
13431   // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return
13432   // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call.
13433   if (ExprEvalContexts.back().IsDecltype) {
13434     ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE);
13435     return false;
13436   }
13437 
13438   class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser {
13439     FunctionDecl *FD;
13440     CallExpr *CE;
13441 
13442   public:
13443     CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE)
13444       : FD(FD), CE(CE) { }
13445 
13446     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
13447       if (!FD) {
13448         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
13449           << T << CE->getSourceRange();
13450         return;
13451       }
13452 
13453       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
13454         << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T;
13455       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
13456           << FD->getDeclName();
13457     }
13458   } Diagnoser(FD, CE);
13459 
13460   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser))
13461     return true;
13462 
13463   return false;
13464 }
13465 
13466 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses
13467 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
13468 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
13469   SourceLocation Loc;
13470 
13471   unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
13472   bool IsOrAssign = false;
13473 
13474   if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
13475     if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign)
13476       return;
13477 
13478     IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign;
13479 
13480     // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
13481     if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
13482           = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
13483       Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
13484 
13485       // self = [<foo> init...]
13486       if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init)
13487         diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
13488 
13489       // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
13490       else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject")
13491         diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
13492     }
13493 
13494     Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
13495   } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
13496     if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual)
13497       return;
13498 
13499     IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual;
13500     Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
13501   } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E))
13502     return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm());
13503   else {
13504     // Not an assignment.
13505     return;
13506   }
13507 
13508   Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
13509 
13510   SourceLocation Open = E->getLocStart();
13511   SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
13512   Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
13513         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
13514         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
13515 
13516   if (IsOrAssign)
13517     Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison)
13518       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!=");
13519   else
13520     Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
13521       << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
13522 }
13523 
13524 /// \brief Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate
13525 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition.
13526 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) {
13527   // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro.
13528   SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart();
13529   if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID())
13530     return;
13531   // Don't warn for dependent expressions.
13532   if (ParenE->isTypeDependent())
13533     return;
13534 
13535   Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens();
13536 
13537   if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
13538     if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ &&
13539         opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context)
13540                                                            == Expr::MLV_Valid) {
13541       SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc();
13542 
13543       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange();
13544       SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange();
13545       Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence)
13546         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin())
13547         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd());
13548       Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign)
13549         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=");
13550     }
13551 }
13552 
13553 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
13554   DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
13555   if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E))
13556     DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE);
13557 
13558   ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
13559   if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13560   E = result.get();
13561 
13562   if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
13563     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13564       return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4
13565 
13566     ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
13567     if (ERes.isInvalid())
13568       return ExprError();
13569     E = ERes.get();
13570 
13571     QualType T = E->getType();
13572     if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
13573       Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
13574         << T << E->getSourceRange();
13575       return ExprError();
13576     }
13577     CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc);
13578   }
13579 
13580   return E;
13581 }
13582 
13583 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
13584                                        Expr *SubExpr) {
13585   if (!SubExpr)
13586     return ExprError();
13587 
13588   return CheckBooleanCondition(SubExpr, Loc);
13589 }
13590 
13591 namespace {
13592   /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression
13593   /// to have an appropriate type.
13594   struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction
13595     : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> {
13596 
13597     Sema &S;
13598 
13599     RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
13600 
13601     ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
13602       llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
13603     }
13604 
13605     ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
13606       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call)
13607         << E->getSourceRange();
13608       return ExprError();
13609     }
13610 
13611     /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
13612     /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
13613     template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
13614       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13615       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13616 
13617       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13618       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13619       E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
13620       E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
13621       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13622       return E;
13623     }
13624 
13625     ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
13626       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13627     }
13628 
13629     ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
13630       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13631     }
13632 
13633     ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
13634       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13635       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13636 
13637       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13638       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13639       E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()));
13640       assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13641       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13642       return E;
13643     }
13644 
13645     ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
13646       if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E);
13647 
13648       E->setType(VD->getType());
13649 
13650       assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13651       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
13652           !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) &&
13653             cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance()))
13654         E->setValueKind(VK_LValue);
13655 
13656       return E;
13657     }
13658 
13659     ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13660       return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
13661     }
13662 
13663     ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13664       return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
13665     }
13666   };
13667 }
13668 
13669 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
13670 /// to have a function type.
13671 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) {
13672   ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr);
13673   if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13674   return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get());
13675 }
13676 
13677 namespace {
13678   /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype
13679   /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring
13680   /// expression.  Strict preservation of the original source
13681   /// structure is not a goal.
13682   struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr
13683     : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> {
13684 
13685     Sema &S;
13686 
13687     /// The current destination type.
13688     QualType DestType;
13689 
13690     RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType)
13691       : S(S), DestType(CastType) {}
13692 
13693     ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
13694       llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
13695     }
13696 
13697     ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
13698       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
13699         << E->getSourceRange();
13700       return ExprError();
13701     }
13702 
13703     ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E);
13704     ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E);
13705 
13706     /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
13707     /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
13708     template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
13709       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13710       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13711       Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13712       E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13713       E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
13714       E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
13715       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13716       return E;
13717     }
13718 
13719     ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
13720       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13721     }
13722 
13723     ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
13724       return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13725     }
13726 
13727     ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
13728       const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>();
13729       if (!Ptr) {
13730         S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof)
13731           << E->getSourceRange();
13732         return ExprError();
13733       }
13734       assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13735       assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13736       E->setType(DestType);
13737 
13738       // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type.
13739       DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13740       ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13741       if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13742       E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get());
13743       return E;
13744     }
13745 
13746     ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E);
13747 
13748     ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD);
13749 
13750     ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13751       return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
13752     }
13753 
13754     ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13755       return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
13756     }
13757   };
13758 }
13759 
13760 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype.
13761 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
13762   Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee();
13763 
13764   enum FnKind {
13765     FK_MemberFunction,
13766     FK_FunctionPointer,
13767     FK_BlockPointer
13768   };
13769 
13770   FnKind Kind;
13771   QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType();
13772   if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) {
13773     assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E));
13774     Kind = FK_MemberFunction;
13775     CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr);
13776   } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
13777     CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13778     Kind = FK_FunctionPointer;
13779   } else {
13780     CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
13781     Kind = FK_BlockPointer;
13782   }
13783   const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>();
13784 
13785   // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function.
13786   if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
13787     unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function;
13788     if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer)
13789       diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function;
13790 
13791     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID)
13792       << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
13793     return ExprError();
13794   }
13795 
13796   // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result.
13797   E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context));
13798   E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
13799   assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13800 
13801   // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType.
13802   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
13803   if (Proto) {
13804     // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when
13805     // it has no idea what a function's signature is.
13806     //
13807     // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R
13808     // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++
13809     // would foul up all sorts of assumptions.  However, we cannot
13810     // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we
13811     // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see
13812     // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic.
13813     // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to
13814     // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype
13815     // "A foo(B,C,D,...);".  The only known exception is with the
13816     // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl
13817     // regardless of its normal CC.  Therefore we change the parameter
13818     // types to match the types of the arguments.
13819     //
13820     // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the
13821     // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST.
13822 
13823     ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes();
13824     SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
13825     if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case
13826       ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs());
13827       for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) {
13828         Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i);
13829         QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
13830         if (E->isLValue()) {
13831           ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType);
13832         } else if (E->isXValue()) {
13833           ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType);
13834         }
13835         ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType);
13836       }
13837       ParamTypes = ArgTypes;
13838     }
13839     DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes,
13840                                          Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
13841   } else {
13842     DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType,
13843                                                 FnType->getExtInfo());
13844   }
13845 
13846   // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type.
13847   switch (Kind) {
13848   case FK_MemberFunction:
13849     // Nothing to do.
13850     break;
13851 
13852   case FK_FunctionPointer:
13853     DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType);
13854     break;
13855 
13856   case FK_BlockPointer:
13857     DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType);
13858     break;
13859   }
13860 
13861   // Finally, we can recurse.
13862   ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr);
13863   if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13864   E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get());
13865 
13866   // Bind a temporary if necessary.
13867   return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
13868 }
13869 
13870 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {
13871   // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call.
13872   if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
13873     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function)
13874       << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
13875     return ExprError();
13876   }
13877 
13878   // Rewrite the method result type if available.
13879   if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) {
13880     assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy);
13881     Method->setReturnType(DestType);
13882   }
13883 
13884   // Change the type of the message.
13885   E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType());
13886   E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
13887 
13888   return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
13889 }
13890 
13891 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
13892   // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay.
13893   if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) {
13894     assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13895     assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13896 
13897     E->setType(DestType);
13898 
13899     // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type.
13900     DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
13901 
13902     ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13903     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13904 
13905     E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
13906     return E;
13907   } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
13908     assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13909     assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13910 
13911     assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType()));
13912 
13913     E->setType(DestType);
13914 
13915     // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such.
13916     DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType);
13917 
13918     ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13919     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13920 
13921     E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
13922     return E;
13923   } else {
13924     llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!");
13925   }
13926 }
13927 
13928 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
13929   ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue;
13930   QualType Type = DestType;
13931 
13932   // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls:
13933 
13934   //  - functions
13935   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) {
13936     if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
13937       DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13938       ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD);
13939       if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13940       return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type,
13941                                  CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue);
13942     }
13943 
13944     if (!Type->isFunctionType()) {
13945       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function)
13946         << VD << E->getSourceRange();
13947       return ExprError();
13948     }
13949     if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
13950       // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in
13951       // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown
13952       // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine.
13953       QualType FDT = FD->getType();
13954       const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>();
13955       const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
13956       DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
13957       if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) {
13958         SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
13959         FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(FD->getASTContext(),
13960                                       FD->getDeclContext(),
13961                                       Loc, Loc, FD->getNameInfo().getName(),
13962                                       DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
13963                                       SC_None, false/*isInlineSpecified*/,
13964                                       FD->hasPrototype(),
13965                                       false/*isConstexprSpecified*/);
13966 
13967         if (FD->getQualifier())
13968           NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc());
13969 
13970         SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
13971         for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
13972           ParmVarDecl *Param =
13973             S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI);
13974           Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
13975           Params.push_back(Param);
13976         }
13977         NewFD->setParams(Params);
13978         DRE->setDecl(NewFD);
13979         VD = DRE->getDecl();
13980       }
13981     }
13982 
13983     if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
13984       if (MD->isInstance()) {
13985         ValueKind = VK_RValue;
13986         Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy;
13987       }
13988 
13989     // Function references aren't l-values in C.
13990     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13991       ValueKind = VK_RValue;
13992 
13993   //  - variables
13994   } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) {
13995     if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
13996       Type = RefTy->getPointeeType();
13997     } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) {
13998       S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type)
13999         << VD << E->getSourceRange();
14000       return ExprError();
14001     }
14002 
14003   //  - nothing else
14004   } else {
14005     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl)
14006       << VD << E->getSourceRange();
14007     return ExprError();
14008   }
14009 
14010   // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but
14011   // also really dangerous.
14012   VD->setType(DestType);
14013   E->setType(Type);
14014   E->setValueKind(ValueKind);
14015   return E;
14016 }
14017 
14018 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type.  We intentionally only
14019 /// trigger this for C-style casts.
14020 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType,
14021                                      Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind,
14022                                      ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) {
14023   // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch.
14024   ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr);
14025   if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
14026 
14027   CastExpr = result.get();
14028   VK = CastExpr->getValueKind();
14029   CastKind = CK_NoOp;
14030 
14031   return CastExpr;
14032 }
14033 
14034 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) {
14035   return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E);
14036 }
14037 
14038 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc,
14039                                     Expr *arg, QualType &paramType) {
14040   // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of
14041   // any sort, just do default argument promotion.
14042   ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens());
14043   if (!castArg) {
14044     ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg);
14045     if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
14046     paramType = result.get()->getType();
14047     return result;
14048   }
14049 
14050   // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast.
14051   assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType());
14052   paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten();
14053 
14054   // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type.
14055   InitializedEntity entity =
14056     InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType,
14057                                            /*consumed*/ false);
14058   return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg);
14059 }
14060 
14061 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
14062   Expr *orig = E;
14063   unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any;
14064   while (true) {
14065     E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
14066     if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
14067       E = call->getCallee();
14068       diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
14069     } else {
14070       break;
14071     }
14072   }
14073 
14074   SourceLocation loc;
14075   NamedDecl *d;
14076   if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
14077     loc = ref->getLocation();
14078     d = ref->getDecl();
14079   } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
14080     loc = mem->getMemberLoc();
14081     d = mem->getMemberDecl();
14082   } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) {
14083     diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
14084     loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc();
14085     d = msg->getMethodDecl();
14086     if (!d) {
14087       S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method)
14088         << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector()
14089         << orig->getSourceRange();
14090       return ExprError();
14091     }
14092   } else {
14093     S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
14094       << E->getSourceRange();
14095     return ExprError();
14096   }
14097 
14098   S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange();
14099 
14100   // Never recoverable.
14101   return ExprError();
14102 }
14103 
14104 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
14105 /// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
14106 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) {
14107   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
14108     // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
14109     // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
14110     // been dealt with before checking the operands.
14111     ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E);
14112     if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
14113     E = Result.get();
14114   }
14115 
14116   const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType();
14117   if (!placeholderType) return E;
14118 
14119   switch (placeholderType->getKind()) {
14120 
14121   // Overloaded expressions.
14122   case BuiltinType::Overload: {
14123     // Try to resolve a single function template specialization.
14124     // This is obligatory.
14125     ExprResult result = E;
14126     if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(result, false)) {
14127       return result;
14128 
14129     // If that failed, try to recover with a call.
14130     } else {
14131       tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable),
14132                            /*complain*/ true);
14133       return result;
14134     }
14135   }
14136 
14137   // Bound member functions.
14138   case BuiltinType::BoundMember: {
14139     ExprResult result = E;
14140     const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens();
14141     PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function);
14142     // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize.
14143     if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) {
14144       PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1;
14145     } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) {
14146       if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() ==
14147           DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName)
14148         PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0;
14149     }
14150     tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD,
14151                          /*complain*/ true);
14152     return result;
14153   }
14154 
14155   // ARC unbridged casts.
14156   case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: {
14157     Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
14158     diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast);
14159     return realCast;
14160   }
14161 
14162   // Expressions of unknown type.
14163   case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
14164     return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E);
14165 
14166   // Pseudo-objects.
14167   case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
14168     return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E);
14169 
14170   case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: {
14171     // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr.
14172     auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
14173     if (DRE) {
14174       auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
14175       if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) {
14176         E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()),
14177                               CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
14178         return new (Context) CallExpr(Context, E, None, Context.IntTy,
14179                                       VK_RValue, SourceLocation());
14180       }
14181     }
14182 
14183     Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use);
14184     return ExprError();
14185   }
14186 
14187   // Everything else should be impossible.
14188 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \
14189   case BuiltinType::Id:
14190 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId)
14191 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
14192     break;
14193   }
14194 
14195   llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!");
14196 }
14197 
14198 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) {
14199   if (E->isTypeDependent())
14200     return true;
14201   if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context))
14202     return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType();
14203   return false;
14204 }
14205 
14206 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals.
14207 ExprResult
14208 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
14209   assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) &&
14210          "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!");
14211   QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy;
14212   if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) {
14213     LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc,
14214                         Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
14215     if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) {
14216       NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl();
14217       if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND))
14218         Context.setBOOLDecl(TD);
14219     }
14220   }
14221   if (Context.getBOOLDecl())
14222     BoolT = Context.getBOOLType();
14223   return new (Context)
14224       ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc);
14225 }
14226